Commit Graph

5215 Commits

Author SHA1 Message Date
Jouni Malinen
a0563ac626 Sync with mac80211-next.git include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h
This brings in nl80211 definitions as of 2015-03-04.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-15 20:35:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8b949804b3 FT: Avoid unnecessary allocation for MIC calculation
Use the vector version of omac1_aes_128() to avoid unnecessary memory
allocation for each FTIE MIC calculation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-15 20:18:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
18da814be7 The master branch is now used for v2.5 development
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-15 19:38:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bc04db9b06 Change version information for the 2.4 release
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-15 19:30:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
319d9daab9 Fix bitfield_get_first_zero() to not read beyond buffer
It was possible for bitfield_get_first_zero() to read one octet beyond
the allocated bit buffer in case the first zero bit was not within
size-1 first octets.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-14 13:50:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
39c3bfcde3 Indicate AP-DISABLED on main AP mode deinit path
This event was previously used only when disabling AP mode operation
through hostapd control interface. Make this more consistent by
providing same indication when disabling hostapd interface through the
interface deinit path. This adds the event to the case where a full
hostapd radio instance is removed which also applies for the
wpa_supplicant AP mode operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-14 10:14:22 +02:00
Rohit Agrawal
00033a0903 OpenSSL: Always accept pinned certificates
If OpenSSL reports that a presented leaf certificate is invalid,
but it has been explicitly pinned, accept it anyway.

Signed-off-by: Rohit Agrawal <rohit.agrawal.mn@gmail.com>
2015-03-07 21:26:26 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
b2329e4ad5 Add QCA vendor subcmd for Data Offload
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-07 19:19:30 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
761396e4be Reject Group Key message 1/2 prior to completion of 4-way handshake
Previously, it would have been possible to complete RSN connection by
skipping the msg 3/4 and 4/4 completely. This would have resulted in
pairwise key not being configured. This is obviously not supposed to
happen in practice and could result in unexpected behavior, so reject
group key message before the initial 4-way handshake has been completed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-07 13:00:06 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
3f0e6ec4f3 nl80211: Extend NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER to support discovery
ML80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION can now set to NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ to
allow the driver to request wpa_supplicant to initiate TDLS Discovery
Request.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 21:13:21 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
c10ca2a66f TDLS: Allow driver to request TDLS Discovery Request initiation
This extends the TDLS operation request mechanism to allow TDLS
Discovery Request to be initiated by the driver similarly to the
existing Setup and Teardown requests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 21:08:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ac8e074ec1 Clear RSN timers for preauth and PTK rekeying on disassociation
Previously, it was possible for the wpa_sm_start_preauth() and
wpa_sm_rekey_ptk() eloop callbacks to remain active after disconnection
and potentially continue to be used for the next association. This is
not correct behavior, so explicitly cancel these timeouts to avoid
unexpected attempts to complete RSN preauthentication or to request PTK
to be rekeyed.

It was possible to trigger this issue, e.g., by running the following
hwsim test case sequence: ap_wpa2_ptk_rekey ap_ft_sae_over_ds

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 18:43:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f2f65dd685 Reserve QCA vendor specific nl80211 commands 61..90
These are reserved for QCA use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 15:46:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bea8d9a39a nl80211: Use the new bridge port option proxyarp_wifi
The initial IEEE 802.11 ProxyARP functionality in the kernel needed
changes in behavior and that ended up requiring an independent
configuration parameter to be used. Update hostapd to use that new
proxyarp_wifi parameter instead of the earlier proxyarp.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-06 11:32:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6e9023ea49 DFS: Allow wpa_supplicant AP mode to use non-offloaded DFS
This extends the hostapd-like setup of DFS-in-userspace for
wpa_supplicant AP mode operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:25:13 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
02e42ab75b nl80211: Add vendor event parsing for DFS offload events
This converts the QCA vendor event to EVENT_DFS_* events for the case
of DFS offloaded to the driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:24:32 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
1e2aaffbc8 DFS offload: Indicate AP-CSA-FINISHED for DFS offloaded case
Modify the string for AP-CSA-FINISHED event indication to include a flag
which tells the framework whether the new channel is a DFS channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:22:03 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
c13578c339 DFS offload: Add main DFS handler for offloaded case
Add handling logic for DFS offloaded case, and add a helper function
that takes the frequency (MHz) as a param and returns 1 if given channel
requires DFS, or 0 otherwise.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 17:21:30 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
5de81d7a7a DFS offload: Skip user space processing for CAC operations
If DFS is offloaded to the driver, hostapd should not be performing
these operations. Send the relevant control interface events to provide
information to upper layer software that may use such events to track
DFS/CAC state. This makes the offloaded DFS implementation more
consistent with the DFS-in-hostapd behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-05 16:24:39 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
dd5c155e2e eap_proxy: Callback to notify any updates from eap_proxy
This commit introduces a callback to notify any configuration updates
from the eap_proxy layer. This is used to trigger re-reading of IMSI and
MNC length.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-02 12:47:20 +02:00
Vivek Natarajan
9a05d98bf9 atheros: Add a new flag for OSEN support
Signed-off-by: Vivek Natarajan <nataraja@qti.qualcomm.com>
2015-03-02 12:40:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b4a9292cfb RADIUS client: Fix server failover on return-to-primary on error case
If a connection with the primary server cannot be established, restore
connection to the previously used server.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 22:36:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1a7ed38670 RADIUS client: Fix a copy-paste error in accounting server failover
Commit 347c55e216 ('RADIUS client: Re-try
connection if socket is closed on retransmit') added a new option for
initialing RADIUS server failover from radius_client_retransmit(), but
ended up trying to change authentication servers when accounting server
was supposed to be changed due to a copy-paste issue.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 22:36:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
de7c06ee17 P2P: Continue find in GO-Neg-Resp-fail status corner cases
It was possible for the GO Negotiation Response (failure) TX status to
be processed at a point where there is no P2P timeout to continue
search. Avoid stopping the ongoing search operation by explicitly
restarting it from this callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-03-01 22:36:52 +02:00
Daisuke Niwa
fa9f381f20 P2P: Allow a specific channel to be specified in P2P_FIND
The optional freq=<MHz> can now be used with the P2P_FIND command to
specify a single channel to scan during the first round of P2P search.
For example, this can be used to replace the full initial scan with a
single channel scan of a known operation channel.

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2015-02-28 21:52:56 +02:00
Daichi Ueura
eb78a8d5e3 P2P: Restore P2P_SCAN_SPECIFIC
This reverts commit 3df2f4fe99 ('P2P:
Remove unused P2P_SCAN_SPECIFIC') with a modification to fit the current
code base.

Signed-off-by: Daichi Ueura <daichi.ueura@sonymobile.com>
2015-02-28 21:41:38 +02:00
Rajkumar Manoharan
d988ff76bf hostapd: Disable VHT caps for STAs when no valid VHT MCS found
Disable VHT caps for STAs for which there is not even a single
allowed MCS in any supported number of streams. i.e STA is
advertising 3 (not supported) as VHT MCS rates for all supported
streams.

Signed-off-by: Rajkumar Manoharan <rmanohar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-28 21:00:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
70fd8287eb RADIUS client: Fix previous failover change
Commit 347c55e216 ('RADIUS client: Re-try
connection if socket is closed on retransmit') added a possibility of
executing RADIUS server failover change within
radius_client_retransmit() without taking into account that this
operation may end up freeing the pending message that is being
processed. This could result in use of freed memory. Avoid this by
checking whether any pending messages have been removed and if so, do
not try to retransmit the potentially freed message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 20:52:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
347c55e216 RADIUS client: Re-try connection if socket is closed on retransmit
Previously, send() was called with invalid fd = -1 in some error cases
for retransmission and this could even result in a loop of multiple such
attempts. This is obviously not going to work, so drop such attempts and
instead, try to reconnect a socket to the server if the current socket
is not valid.

In addition, initiate server failover immediately if the current socket
is not valid instead of waiting for a timeout.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 16:40:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
94b39e5927 RADIUS client: Fix server connection recovery after initial failure
If the initial attempt at opening the socket connection to the RADIUS
server failed due to missing IP connectivity during startup, e.g., with
"connect[radius]: Network is unreachable", hostapd did not try to
reconnect when RADIUS messages were sent. Instead, it only reported "No
authentication server configured" even if the configuration did have a
server entry.

This was broken by commit 9ed4076673
('RADIUS client: Do not try to send message without socket') for the
initial case and the more recent fixes in RADIUS server failover cases
did not cover the initial failure case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 15:45:17 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
efb40081ab TLS: Remove placeholders for SIGN_ALG_DSA support
It does not look likely that the old DSA design would be added into the
internal TLS implement, so remove this otherwise dead code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 15:45:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2eb64ea437 tests: Module tests for common.c
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 12:20:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
56a1180153 tests: Increase bitfield module test coverage
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 11:46:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
38ff21931d tests: Add module tests for base64
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-28 11:39:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f51f54a007 nl80211: Resubscribe to nl80211 events on global nl_event socket
This allows wpa_supplicant to recover from some of the cases where
cfg80211 is unloaded and reloaded without restarting wpa_supplicant. The
netlink socket used for nl80211 events (global->nl_event) seemed to end
up in otherwise functionality state, but with all the event memberships
lost when cfg80211 gets reloaded.

There does not seem to be any clear way of determining when this has
happened, so it looks simplest to just try to re-subscribe to all the
events whenever an interface is re-enabled or added.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 18:03:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
48ec6942cb Fix Linux packet socket workaround to not close the socket too easily
Commit e6dd8196e5 ('Work around Linux
packet socket regression') closed the workaround socket on the first
received EAPOL frame from the main packet socket. This can result in
closing the socket in cases where the kernel does not really work in the
expected way during the following initial association since
reauthentication/rekeying using EAPOL frames happens while operstate is
not dormant and as such, the frames can get delivered through the main
packet socket.

Fix this by closing the workaround socket only in case the first EAPOL
frame is received through the main packet socket. This case happens
while the interface is in dormant state and as such, is more likely to
show the more restricted case of kernel functionality.

In order to avoid processing the received EAPOL frames twice, verify a
checksum of the frame contents when receiving frames alternatively from
the main packet socket and the workaround socket.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 16:06:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d747e2a98 Add snr and est_throughput to the BSS entries
These values were previously used only for sorting the scan results, but
it may be useful to provide access to the used values through the BSS
entries.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 11:09:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a1b790eb9d Select AP based on estimated maximum throughput
This modifies the BSS selection routines to calculate SNR and estimated
throughput for each scan result and then use the estimated throughput as
a criteria for sorting the results. This extends the earlier design by
taking into account higher throughput rates if both the AP and local
device supports HT20, HT40, or VHT80. In addition, the maximum rate is
restricted based on SNR.

In practice, this gives significantly higher probability of selecting
HT/VHT APs when there are multiple BSSes in the same ESS and SNR is not
low enough to prevent higher MCS use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-22 11:09:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
abae2d1a3c trace: Initialize alloc_list even without os_program_init() call
This makes it somewhat easier to use CONFIG_WPA_TRACE=y build with
external programs that might not be aware of the initialization
requirement, e.g., when linking wpa_ctrl.c with a program that does not
use the os_*() wrappers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-21 17:34:37 +02:00
Stefan Tomanek
891dfb3336 Add helper function to clear and free wpa_psk list
This change adds the function hostapd_config_clear_wpa_psk() that
deletes an entire wpa_psk structure, making sure to follow the linked
list and to free the allocated memory of each PSK node. This helps to
prevent memory leaks when using PSKs from multiple sources and
reconfiguring the AP during runtime.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Tomanek <stefan.tomanek@wertarbyte.de>
2015-02-21 17:11:15 +02:00
Eliad Peller
abb8d08b8a nl80211: Add support for configuring P2P GO CTWindow
Configure the GO CTWindow on APstart if the driver supports it and this
parameter is set in wpa_supplicant configuration.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Eliad Peller
0b8bcaa50f P2P: Allow configuring CTWindow when working as GO
Read p2p_go_ctwindow (0-127 TUs) from the config file, and pass it to
the driver on GO start.

Use p2p_go_ctwindow=0 (no CTWindow) by default.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
c77ffc6daf TDLS: Ignore extra padding in all packets
Some APs (e.g., Cisco 1260) sometimes add padding to the end of short
TDLS management packets and that can look like invalid IEs. This was
allowed on M3 and discovery packets, but not in others. Allow it for the
other packets as well, since required IEs are verified in the code
anyway.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
563ee1832b IBSS: Add support for VHT80 configuration
Configure VHT80 based on driver capabilities.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
ada157f3b0 Make hostapd_set_freq_params() common
Now this function can also be used from wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
4d9e6fba2a IBSS: Add fixed_freq network parameter
Add fixed_freq=<0/1> network block parameter and pass it to the driver
when starting or joining an IBSS. If this flag is set, IBSS should not
try to look for other IBSS networks to merge with on different channels.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-02-21 16:07:53 +02:00
Romain Naour
97fc2dc612 Allow libnl-3.0 include path be specified
The '/usr/include/libnl3' header path is unsafe for cross-compilation.
Use pkg-config to find libnl-3.0 headers by default and alternatively,
allow LIBNL_INC=<path> to be used in .config to override.

Signed-off-by: Romain Naour <romain.naour@openwide.fr>
2015-02-21 11:36:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
58d405fcdb Fix OCSP debug messages
These were not supposed to include a newline at the end of the message
text since such formatting gets handled by tls_show_errors(). In
addition, change the message about the issuer's issuer to be more
accurate.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-19 13:33:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
710dfb4e32 OpenSSL: Fix OCSP error path
If addition of a peer issuer certificate fails, the certs pointer would
be NULL when being passed to sk_X509_push() for peer issuer's issuer.
Fix this by skipping addition of issuer's issue if issuer addition
fails.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-19 13:32:05 +02:00
Subhani Shaik
bd7bb43784 HTTP: Fix OCSP error path
If addition of a peer issuer certificate fails, the certs pointer would
be NULL when being passed to sk_X509_push() for peer issuer's issuer.
Fix this by skipping addition of issuer's issue if issuer addition
fails.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-19 13:29:55 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
480994dafb nl80211: Allocate QCA vendor subcmds for DFS radar detected and CAC events
When DFS offloading capability is supported by the driver, the driver
should use these events to indicate when a radar pattern has been
detected, channel availability check (CAC) has been completed, aborted
or finished after the non-occupancy period is over on a DFS channel.

Also, add a new driver.h event to be used by NL80211 to indicate CAC
Started event on a DFS channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-11 16:51:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c165cb400c Drop all hostapd STA entries on interface disabled event
If the driver indicates that the interface has been disabled, assume
that all associations have been lost and remove the hostapd STA entries.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-11 10:31:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
106fa1e97e nl80211: Indicate interface-down event only for the main netdev
RTM_NEWLINK event without IFF_UP were processed for all related
interfaces (including VLANs and bridge). While these events may need to
be processed for other purposes, they should not end up claiming that
the main interface has been disabled, so indicate
EVENT_INTERFACE_DISABLED only if the ifname matches the first BSS ifname
for the interface. In addition, fix some of the ifup/down checks from
if_indextoname() cases to actually use the resolved ifname (namebuf)
rather than hardcoding the first configured ifname to be used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-11 10:31:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
eeb1cb28a2 VLAN: Clean up RTM_NEW/DELLINK processing
This uses couple of additional helper macros and prints more debug
information to make the VLAN events easier to analyze.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-11 10:31:12 +02:00
Peter Oh
47e5fbde44 hostapd: Avoid sending client probe on removed client
Sending client probe on already removed client from kernel driver does
not have any benefit and may lead unintended behavior among variable
drivers (mac80211 has a WARN_ON() that could have been triggered after
ifconfig down+up earlier when hostapd did not re-enable beaconing on
ifup). Skip this step in discussion when the kernel driver reports that
client entry is removed.

Signed-off-by: Peter Oh <poh@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-10 22:21:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
34782730c0 Re-configure WPA2 group keys on hostapd interface re-enable
This allows WPA2 mode AP to be re-enabled automatically after external
ifconfig down + up on a netdev used by hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-10 20:27:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f33c8606f4 Re-enable beaconing on interface disable+enable
This is a step towards enabling hostapd to restart AP mode functionality
if the interface is disabled and re-enabled, e.g., with ifconfig down
and up. This commit takes care of beaconining only which may be
sufficient for open mode connection, but not for WPA2 cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-10 20:27:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fc99fab7e5 nl80211: Print a debug log entry on NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT failures
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-10 20:27:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0d2f324d67 P2P: Fix send_action_in_progress clearing in corner cases
It is possible for an Action frame TX operation to be stopped in a way
that results in the TX status callback function not being called. This
could happen, e.g., when P2P_STOP_FIND was issued while waiting for PD
Response TX status. This specific case ended in leaving
p2p->send_action_in_progress set to 1 and that ending up stopping a
future TX operation when p2p_send_action_cb() gets called with
p2p->pending_action_state == P2P_NO_PENDING_ACTION.

This could result in reception of a fragmented service discovery
response failing due to the GAS sequence getting stopped when receiving
TX callback for the first GAS comeback request. That sequence could be
hit in mac80211_hwsim tests when p2p_listen_and_offchannel_tx was
followed by p2p_service_discovery_fragmentation (even after a long time
since this was on dev1 and there could be even 10 minutes between these
test cases).

Fix this issue by clearing send_action_in_progress whenever stopping
pending P2P operation with p2p_stop_find (or P2P_FLUSH for that matter).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-10 00:41:27 +02:00
Ahmad Kholaif
e0761c5b4a nl80211: Allocate QCA vendor subcmd for DFS CAC Start event
When DFS offloading capability is supported by the driver, the driver
should use this event to indicate when channel availability check (CAC)
is started on a DFS channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-09 18:48:36 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1db718b3ce nl80211: Test vendor command and event
This adds testing code (for CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds only) to
send an nl80211 vendor command and report a test vendor event in case
the driver supports this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-09 18:07:29 +02:00
Ilan Peer
c612ae97a4 AP: Do not reply to Probe Request frames with DS Params mismatch
Do not reply to a Probe Request frame with a DSSS Parameter Set element
in which the channel is different than the operating channel of the AP,
as the sending station is not found on the AP's operating channel.

IEEE Std 802.11-2012 describes this as a requirement for an AP with
dot11RadioMeasurementActivated set to true, but strictly speaking does
not allow such ignoring of Probe Request frames if
dot11RadioMeasurementActivated is false. Anyway, this can help reduce
number of unnecessary Probe Response frames for cases where the STA is
less likely to see them (Probe Request frame sent on a neighboring, but
partially overlapping, channel).

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-02-08 22:49:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
99650cadc9 Add STOP_AP control interface command
This is mainly for testing purposes to allow beaconing to be stopped
without clearing AP state in hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 13:35:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6b00512164 P2P: Add event messages for P2P_CONNECT-fallback-to-GO-Neg
This makes it easier for upper layer programs to follow progress of
P2P_CONNECT-auto operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-08 13:35:48 +02:00
Masashi Honma
79ddb2062e mesh: Add a monitor event on SAE authentication getting blocked
Send MESH-SAE-AUTH-BLOCKED event if SAE authentication is blocked. The
BLOCK state will finish when a new peer notification event is sent for
the same MAC address.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-02-07 22:33:23 +02:00
Masashi Honma
dd2cbafc89 mesh: Add a monitor event for SAE authentication failure
SAE authentication fails likely with wrong password. This commit adds a
notification of the failure to the upper application (UI) so that the
application can notify suspection of a wrong password to the user. The
control interface monitor even for this is "MESH-SAE-AUTH-FAILURE
addr=<peer>".

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-02-07 22:23:34 +02:00
Masashi Honma
0cb5f8d945 mesh: Fix inactivity timer for 32 bit system
Commit 5a2a6de6a5 ('mesh: Make inactivity
timer configurable') has a problem on 32 bit systems. Setting
NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT to 0xffffffff causes expiration of STA in
a minute by NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION event. this is the kernel rule for
STA expiration:

(current jiffies) > (frame Rx jiffies + NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT * 250)

On a 32 bit system, the right side could overflow and be unexpected
small value if NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT is sufficiently large. STA
expiration occurs by this reason.

This patch solves the problem by disabling the STA expiration
functionality in mac80211. However, old kernel does not support
disabling it. If so, this patch sets mac80211 inactivity timer 60
seconds into future from the wpa_supplicant inactivity timer.

And I mis-understood that mesh_max_inactivity=0 disables inactivity
timer in wpa_supplicant. This commit fixes it also.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-02-07 22:20:45 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4fada1215d Fix HT40 co-ex scanning issue on hostapd error path
If HT40 co-ex scan fails due to the driver rejecting scan triggers
multiple times, it was possible for the ap_ht40_scan_retry() timeout
being left behind and it getting run after hapd->drv_priv has been
cleared. This would result in NULL pointer dereference in
driver_nl80211_scan.c. Fix this by canceling the timeout when disabling
the interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-07 15:37:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
23ed011bea Fix Linux packat socket regression work around
Commit e6dd8196e5 ('Work around Linux
packet socket regression') added a mechanism to close the workaround
bridge socket in l2_packet_receive(). However, it did not take into
account the possibility of the l2->rx_callback() closing the l2_packet
socket altogether. This could result in use of freed memory when usin
RSN pre-authentication. Fix this by reordering the calls to clear the
workaround socket before calling the rx_callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-07 15:37:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0d7eb4344f ACS: Accept channel if any (rather than all) survey results are valid
Previously, a channel with even a single scan/survey result missing
information was skipped in ACS. This may not be desirable in cases when
multiple scan iterations are used (which is the case by default in
hostapd). Instead, use all channels that provided at least one complete
set of results. Calculate the average interference factor as an average
of the iterations that did provide complete values.

This seems to help with some cases, e.g., when ath9k may not be able to
report the noise floor for all channels from the first scan iteration
immediately after the driver has been loaded, but then returns it for
all other scan iterations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-06 21:26:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
68fa00c341 ACS: Allow specific channels to be preferred
The new acs_chan_bias configuration parameter is a space-separated list
of <channel>:<bias> pairs. It can be used to increase (or decrease) the
likelihood of a specific channel to be selected by the ACS algorithm.
The total interference factor for each channel gets multiplied by the
specified bias value before finding the channel with the lowest value.
In other words, values between 0.0 and 1.0 can be used to make a channel
more likely to be picked while values larger than 1.0 make the specified
channel less likely to be picked. This can be used, e.g., to prefer the
commonly used 2.4 GHz band channels 1, 6, and 11 (which is the default
behavior on 2.4 GHz band if no acs_chan_bias parameter is specified).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-06 17:59:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6f41a25805 ACS: Use weighted average for 2.4 GHz adjacent channel interference
The interference factors for adjacent 2.4 GHz channels were summed
together without doing any kind of weighted average on them. This
resulted in the channels at the band edges getting undue preference due
to only including interference factors from three channels vs. five for
the channels in the middle of the band.

While it is somewhat unclear whether the design here was supposed to
count overlapping channels together in this way or whether that is
already covered in channel survey results, it is clear that this summing
of three to five values together and then comparing the sum rather than
average of some kind gives too much preference to the channels at the
edges of the band by assuming that there is no interference whatsoever
outside the band.

Use weighted average of the interference factors rather than a sum from
different number of values. For now, the adjacent 2.4 GHz channels get
weight of 0.85 (1.0 for the main channel itself) and the neighboring
channels to those adjacent ones get 0.55 weight. Band-edge channels are
handled in a way that takes average over the channels that were actually
considered instead of assuming zero interference from neighboring bands.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-06 17:21:17 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
2c0efd9e49 P2P: Fix stopping on search after SD callback
If p2p_find_timeout triggers after starting SD but before getting TX
status for send action, unwanted search could get triggered again when
TX status arrives though p2p_find_timeout moved the state to P2P_IDLE by
then. p2p_continue_find() would then move the state to P2P_SEARCH again.
Do not trigger the find operation from this context if state is
P2P_IDLE to avoid this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-04 20:46:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
db3168d414 OpenSSL: Use SSL_cache_hit() when available
This is going to be required for OpenSSL 1.1.0 which makes the SSL
structure opaque. Older versions starting from OpenSSL 1.0.1 include
this function, so start using it now based on OPENSSL_VERSION_NUMBER.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-04 02:04:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
68ae4773a4 OpenSSL: Use library wrapper functions to access cert store
OpenSSL 0.9.8 and newer includes SSL_CTX_get_cert_store() and
SSL_CTX_set_cert_store() helper functions, so there is no need to
dereference the SSL_CTX pointer to cert ssl_ctx->cert_store. This helps
in working with the future OpenSSL 1.1.0 release that makes the SSL_CTX
structure opaque.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-04 01:58:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
abe96d0605 P2P: Clean up Listen channel optimization debug prints
Do not claim to change the Listen channel in a debug message when
previously configured channel prevents this. In addition, fix a typo in
another related debug print.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 16:13:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d027c7b118 Fix 20/40 MHz co-ex report processing with obss_interval=0
If OBSS scan interval is not set, the AP must not schedule a timeout to
restore 40 MHz operation immediately after having moved to a 20 MHz
channel based on an unsolicited co-ex report. Fix this by scheduling the
timeout only if obss_interval is non-zero.

Since we do not currently support AP doing OBSS scans after the initial
BSS setup, this means practically that 40-to-20 MHz transition is
allowed, but 20-to-40 MHz is not with obss_interval=0. The latter gets
enabled if obss_interval is set to a non-zero value so that associated
STAs can take care of OBSS scanning.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 12:29:37 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
ae2dd835be P2PS: Allow PD retry in SEARCH and LISTEN_ONLY also
p2p_timeout_prov_disc_req is getting triggered in P2P_IDLE,
P2P_SEARCH and P2P_LISTEN_ONLY states. Retry logic should not be
limited to only P2P_IDLE state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
0cf12b322d P2PS: Send P2P_FIND_STOPPED event during P2P SD also
During service discovery if P2P_FIND times out, P2P_FIND_STOPPED event
is sent to upper layers to allow follow up P2P_FIND commands. This needs
to be done also in case an SD was in progress during the find operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
9e96e46456 P2PS: PD Response processing
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
ab8ee776b9 P2PS: Provision Discovery fail event
This extends P2P-PROV-DISC-FAILURE with adv_id and deferred_session_resp
in P2PS cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
1300cc8e8f P2PS: PD Request processing and PD Response building
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
5fefce2747 P2PS: Callback to send P2PS provisioning events
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
9a58e521ac P2PS: Callback to create pending group after sending PD Response
This introduces a P2P module callback function that will be used to
create the pending P2PS group after sending PD Response and receiving
ACK status for it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
895d94def9 P2PS: Callback to remove stale persistent groups
When the peer device is trying to form a new group despite having
old persistent group with same roles, remove the stale persistent
group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
6d9085145c P2PS: Process P2PS provisioning commands
This extends wpas_p2p_prov_disc() implementation to accept P2PS
parameters. None of the callers are yet using this functionality; the
following commit introduces a user.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
369678ad14 P2PS: Add P2PS attributes into PD Request if requested
This adds a data structure for storing P2PS PD information and code to
add the related attributes into PD Request. The actual operation to
trigger this behavior will be added in a separate commit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:07 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
59fec34d9c P2PS: Allow p2p_build_ssid() to use pre-set SSID
This is needed to allow P2PS PD to prepare SSID for the group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
d4b43b5886 P2PS: Add support to send ASP-RESP events
Send P2P-SERV-ASP-RESP events upon receiving GAS responses with
ASP services.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
6df08d0341 P2PS: Logic to parse GAS requests for ASP services
Add support to parse received GAS requests for ASP services and
prepare GAS responses accordingly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Brian Gix
095b3c4069 P2PS: Add Application Service Info to device found events
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Brian Gix
4660e73213 P2PS: Add Advertised Service Info into Probe Response frames
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
9e7321eea4 P2PS: Parse Probe Request frames for matching ASP hashes
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
ae9d45f329 P2PS: Extend add/del services logic to support ASP
In addition, add a new P2P_SERVICE_REP command that can be used to
replace existing ASP advertisements.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-03 01:35:06 +02:00
Brian Gix
ea8e033e92 P2P: Allow p2p_get_group_num_members() to be called with NULL
This make it easier to use wpa_s->p2p_group without having to check
whether there is a group initialized on this wpa_s instance.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 16:55:45 +02:00
Brian Gix
4f88fc0464 P2PS: WPS changes needed for P2PS default PIN
This provides additional WPS definitions and rules for negotiating use
of P2PS default PIN configuration method.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 16:55:45 +02:00
Brian Gix
1a94b0adcc P2PS: Add service hash to Probe Request frames
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 16:55:45 +02:00
Brian Gix
5177509657 P2PS: Add option to specify seek strings into P2P_FIND
P2PS seek strings can now be specified in the P2P_FIND control interface
command with one or more optional "seek=<str>" parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 16:55:43 +02:00
Krishna Vamsi
5f18501f46 P2PS: Helper functions to build new P2P attributes
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:19 +02:00
Brian Gix
60d11488ff P2PS: Add parsing of new P2P attributes
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:19 +02:00
Brian Gix
b9348be18e P2PS: Add new P2P identifier assignments from P2P spec v1.5
These will be used for P2P Services.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:19 +02:00
Brian Gix
c3d6c71782 Add helper functions for escaping and unescaping UTF-8
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c5e154c037 P2P: Add P2P state into p2p_send_action_cb() debug entry
This makes it easier to debug issues related to ongoing P2P operations
getting stopped due to Action frame exchanges.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-02-02 14:09:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7f7bfba919 Add an option allow canned EAP-Success for wired IEEE 802.1X
For wired IEEE 802.1X authentication, phase1="allow_canned_success=1"
can now be used to configure a mode that allows EAP-Success (and
EAP-Failure) without going through authentication step. Some switches
use such sequence when forcing the port to be authorized/unauthorized or
as a fallback option if the authentication server is unreachable. By
default, wpa_supplicant discards such frames to protect against
potential attacks by rogue devices, but this option can be used to
disable that protection for cases where the server/authenticator does
not need to be authenticated.

When enabled, this mode allows EAP-Success/EAP-Failure as an immediate
response to EAPOL-Start (or even without EAPOL-Start) and EAP-Success is
also allowed immediately after EAP-Identity exchange (fallback case for
authenticator not being able to connect to authentication server).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-01 19:22:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
49fcc32e91 EAP-MSCHAPv2 peer: Add option to disable password retry query
wpa_supplicant used to request user to re-enter username/password if the
server indicated that EAP-MSCHAPv2 (e.g., in PEAP Phase 2)
authentication failed (E=691), but retry is allowed (R=1). This is a
reasonable default behavior, but there may be cases where it is more
convenient to close the authentication session immediately rather than
wait for user to do something.

Add a new "mschapv2_retry=0" option to the phase2 field to allow the
retry behavior to be disabled. This will make wpa_supplicant abort
authentication attempt on E=691 regardless of whether the server allows
retry.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-02-01 17:45:19 +02:00
Helmut Schaa
66bc6830d5 hostapd: Simplify vlan_add_dynamic error paths
Preparation for upcoming changes.
No functional changes.

Signed-off-by: Helmut Schaa <helmut.schaa@googlemail.com>
2015-02-01 11:06:24 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e6dd8196e5 Work around Linux packet socket regression
Linux kernel commit 576eb62598f10c8c7fd75703fe89010cdcfff596 ('bridge:
respect RFC2863 operational state') from 2012 introduced a regression
for using wpa_supplicant with EAPOL frames and a station interface in a
bridge. Since it does not look like this regression is going to get
fixed any time soon (it is already two years from that commit and over
1.5 from a discussion pointing out the regression), add a workaround in
wpa_supplicant to avoid this issue.

The wpa_supplicant workaround uses a secondary packet socket to capture
all frames (ETH_P_ALL) from the netdev that is in a bridge. This is
needed to avoid the kernel regression. However, this comes at the price
of more CPU load. Some of this is avoided with use of Linux socket
filter, but still, this is less efficient than a packet socket bound to
the specific EAPOL ethertype. The workaround gets disabled
automatically, if the main packet socket interface on the bridge
interface turns out to be working for RX (e.g., due to an old kernel
version being used or a new kernel version having a fix for the
regression). In addition, this workaround is only taken into use for the
special case of running wpa_supplicant with an interface in a bridge.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-31 17:21:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7650f9e7d8 Fix resource leaks on rsn_preauth_init() error paths
The l2_packet instances were not freed on some of the rsn_preauth_init()
error paths.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-31 13:44:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a565e03086 dhcp_snoop: Make IPv4 addresses human readable in debug log
Use standard numbers-and-dots format for IPv4 in debug logs instead
of hexdump in two different byte orders.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-30 18:55:22 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2dd4f3aede Fix STA re-bind to another VLAN on reauthentication
Previously, the old VLAN ID could have been deleted before the STA was
bound to the new VLAN in case the RADIUS server changed the VLAN ID
during an association. This did not exactly work well with mac80211, so
reorder the operations in a way that first binds the STA to the new VLAN
ID and only after that, removes the old VLAN interface if no STAs remain
in it.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-30 01:09:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1180dd66a9 WPA auth: Disconnect STA if MSK cannot be fetched
Previously, it was possible for some corner cases to leave the WPA
authenticator state machine running if PMK could not be derived. Change
this to forcefully disconnect the STA to get more consistent behavior
and faster notification of the error.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-29 22:31:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
40aaa64f9f WPA auth: Clear temporary MSK storage from stack explicitly
This reduces the duration of time a key may remain unnecessarily in
memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-29 22:24:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
01b481aff3 Convert couple of remaining printf to wpa_printf in ap_list
This type of error reporting cases should use wpa_printf() to get
consistent debug logging behavior.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-29 21:12:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bfaefd5174 EAP-PEAP server: Fix Phase 2 TLV length in error case
The payload length in a Phase 2 TLV message reporting error was not set
correctly. Fix this to not include the TLVs that are included only in
success case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 16:15:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
467775c5ac tests: Pending EAP peer processing with VENDOR-TEST
This extends the VENDOR-TEST EAP method peer implementation to allow
pending processing case to be selected at run time. The
ap_wpa2_eap_vendor_test test case is similarly extended to include this
option as the second case for full coverage.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ba4226130e Simplify eapol_sm_notify_pmkid_attempt()
Drop the unneeded 'attempt' argument. This was originally used for
indicating an aborted PMKID caching attempt, but a fix in 2006 removed
the only such user and since that time, only attempt == 1 has been used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
993a865407 Add eap_session_id to wpa_supplicant STATUS output
This makes the current EAP Session-Id available for external programs.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f19c907822 OpenSSL: Implement aes_wrap() and aes_unwrap()
This replaces the implementation in aes-wrap.c and aes-unwrap.c with
OpenSSL AES_wrap_key() and AES_unwrap_key() functions when building
hostapd or wpa_supplicant with OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fee31f76cd OpenSSL: Remove support for versions older than 0.9.8
These have reached out-of-life status in the OpenSSL project and there
is no need to maintain support for them in hostapd/wpa_supplicant
either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8bf3030af6 OpenSSL: Use a common helper function for HMAC
There is no need to duplicate this construction for each hash algorithm.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
983c6a606b OpenSSL: Replace internal HMAC-MD5 implementation
Use OpenSSL HMAC_* functions to implement HMAC-MD5 instead of depending
on the src/crypto/md5.c implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-28 13:09:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fa38860c5e nl80211: Fix build with libnl 1.1
Commit 630b3230c8 ('nl80211: Increase
netlink receive buffer size') added unconditional use of
nl_socket_set_buffer_size() which was not included in libnl 1.1. Fix use
of that old version by making this conditional on CONFIG_LIBNL20.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:50:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
399e61353a Add Suite B AKMs to key_mgmt capability list
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:43:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5e3b5197cc Add Suite B 192-bit AKM
WPA-EAP-SUITE-B-192 can now be used to select 192-bit level Suite B into
use as the key management method.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:43:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
97ae35a848 Add HMAC-SHA384
For now, this is only implemented with OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:26:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
98cd3d1c3b Preparations for variable length KCK and KEK
This modifies struct wpa_ptk to allow the length of KCK and KEK to be
stored. This is needed to allow longer keys to be used, e.g., with
Suite B 192-bit level.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-27 01:26:49 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
30bff1d0f4 Extend AES-CMAC routines to support 256-bit keys
omac1_aes_256() and omac1_aes_vector() can now be used to perform
256-bit CMAC operations similarly to the previously supported 128-bit
cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-24 19:37:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
86f9b1c706 nl80211: Fix default group key management index configuration
The correct nl80211 flag for group key management cipher was set only
for BIP (AES-CMAC-128). The same flag needs to be used with the newer
ciphers BIP-CMAC-256, BIP-GMAC-128, and BIP-GMAC-256.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-24 19:37:42 +02:00
Ben Greear
400de9b1fe hostapd: Debug messages for dodgy RADIUS servers
These were helpful when tracking down why hostapd did not work
properly with a RADIUS server.

Signed-hostap: Ben Greear <greearb@candelatech.com>
2015-01-23 01:48:27 +02:00
Ola Olsson
bff162ac76 P2P: Fix NULL pointer dereference with SD query cancellation
A NULL pointer crash was caused by commit
7139cf4a4f ('P2P: Decrement
sd_pending_bcast_queries when sd returns'). p2p->sd_query can be cleared
to NULL whenever a query is cancelled, even in case the request had
already been transmitted. As such, need to be prepared for the query not
remaining when processing TX status callback for the frame.

Crashes on 2ee98 in following code
2ee90:       f7fc f8b6       bl      2b000 <p2p_dbg>
2ee94:       e02c            b.n     2eef0 <p2p_send_action_cb+0x348>
2ee96:       6c25            ldr     r5, [r4, #64]   ; 0x40
2ee98:       68ee            ldr     r6, [r5, #12]
2ee9a:       b166            cbz     r6, 2eeb6 <p2p_send_action_cb+0x30e>

Signed-off-by: Ola Olsson <ola.olsson@sonymobile.com>
2015-01-22 15:49:37 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
630b3230c8 nl80211: Increase netlink receive buffer size
libnl uses a pretty small buffer (32 kB that gets converted to 64 kB) by
default. It is possible to hit that limit in some cases where operations
are blocked, e.g., with a burst of Deauthentication frames to hostapd
and STA entry deletion. Try to increase the buffer to make this less
likely to occur.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-22 13:51:15 +02:00
ASHUTOSH NARAYAN
fb09ed3389 Interworking: Notify the ANQP parsing status
The ANQP verification/parsing is done only after the GAS_DONE indication
is sent over the control interface. This means that in case the ANQP
parsing fails there is no indication to the upper layers. Add an
ANQP-QUERY-DONE event that reports the status of the ANQP parsing.

Signed-off-by: ASHUTOSH NARAYAN <ashutoshx.narayan@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:26:21 +02:00
Haim Dreyfuss
b62b0cb78a WNM: Fix possible memory leak by free buf
Buf is allocated and may not be freed on an error path.

Signed-off-by: Haim Dreyfuss <haim.dreyfuss@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:14:19 +02:00
Ben
9bd0273931 EAP: Fix possible memory leak in eap_ttls_process_decrypted()
In case eap_peer_tls_encrypt() fails in eap_ttls_process_decrypted(),
free resp memory.

Signed-off-by: Ben Rosenfeld <ben.rosenfeld@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:13:15 +02:00
Haim Dreyfuss
b760e64276 eap_server: Avoid NULL pointer dereference in eap_fast_encrypt_phase2()
If TLS encryption fails, encr may be NULL and that would have resulted
in NULL pointer dereference..

Signed-off-by: Haim Dreyfuss <haim.dreyfuss@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:11:59 +02:00
Avraham Stern
948d3a8731 hostapd: Remove unused variable from hostapd_get_hw_features
Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:10:33 +02:00
Eytan Lifshitz
414f23d8b9 Avoid NULL string in printf on EAP method names in authenticator
In ieee802_1x_decapsulate_radius(), eap_server_get_name() may return
NULL, and it could be dereferenced depending on printf implementation.
Change it to return "unknown" instead for the case of no matching EAP
method found. This makes it easier for the callers to simply print this
in logs (which is the only use for this function).

Signed-off-by: Eytan Lifshitz <eytan.lifshitz@intel.com>
2015-01-20 02:07:22 +02:00
Luciano Coelho
7b7b4449a9 nl80211: Fix reading of the extended capabilities mask
We were copying the NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA attribute into the
extended_capa_mask element, which is incorrect. Use
NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK instead.

Signed-off-by: Luciano Coelho <luciano.coelho@intel.com>
2015-01-20 01:57:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6b46bfa751 WPS: Re-fix an interoperability issue with mixed mode and AP Settings
Commit ce7b56afab ('WPS: Fix an
interoperability issue with mixed mode and AP Settings') added code to
filter M7 Authentication/Encryption Type attributes into a single bit
value in mixed mode (WPA+WPA2) cases to work around issues with Windows
7. This workaround was lost in commit
d7a15d5953 ('WPS: Indicate current AP
settings in M7 in unconfigurated state') that fixed unconfigured state
values in AP Settings, but did not take into account the earlier
workaround for mixed mode.

Re-introduce filtering of Authentication/Encryption Type attributes for
M7 based on the current AP configuration. In other words, merge those
two earlier commits together to include both the earlier workaround the
newer fix.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-19 18:35:59 +02:00
Adrien Decostre
1648cc6427 ACS: Allow subset of channels to be configured
Add the possibility to define a subset of channels used by the ACS
engine when not operating on DFS channels.

Signed-off-by: Adrien Decostre <ad.decostre@gmail.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
95ff306988 nl80211: Allow HT/VHT to be disabled for IBSS
Allow HT/VHT overrides to be used for IBSS.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Masashi Honma
7451a217be mesh: Return negative value on join failed
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Masashi Honma
5a2a6de6a5 mesh: Make inactivity timer configurable
Current mesh code uses ap_max_inactivity as inactivity timer. This patch
makes it configurable.

There is another mesh inactivity timer in mac80211. The timer works even
if user_mpm=1. So this patch sets the max value to the timer for
workaround.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Masashi Honma
b9749bac81 AP: Expire STA without entry in kernel
If the inactivity check returns that there is no entry remaining for the
STA in the kernel, drop the STA in hostapd as well.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Masashi Honma
a114c7235a AP: Remove redundant condition for STA expiration
This condition is always true because of surrounding if.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0d787f0242 Fix RADIUS client with out-of-memory and missing shared secret
It was possible for an out-of-memory code path to trigger NULL pointer
dereference when preparing a RADIUS accounting report.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-19 02:35:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cbc210de09 RADIUS DAS: Allow PMKSA cache entry to be removed without association
This extends Disconnect-Request processing to check against PMKSA cache
entries if no active session (STA association) match the request.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-16 15:55:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4e871ed1c3 RADIUS DAS: Support Acct-Multi-Session-Id as a session identifier
This extends Disconnect-Request support for an additiona session
identification attribute.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-16 13:09:44 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b52c0d453f Add authMultiSessionId into hostapd STA info
dot1xAuthSessionId was previously used to make Acct-Session-Id available
through the control interface. While there is no IEEE 802.1X MIB
variable for Acct-Multi-Session-Id, it is useful to make this value
available as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-16 13:07:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
861beb7269 RADIUS DAS: Check for single session match for Disconnect-Request
Previously, the first matching STA was picked. That is not really the
design in RFC 5176, so extend this matching code to go through all
specified session identification attributes and verify that all of them
match. In addition, check for a possible case of multiple sessions
matching. If such a case is detected, return with Disconnect-NAK and
Error-Code 508 (multiple session selection not supported).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-16 12:50:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1fef85c7c5 nl80211: Fix AP-scan-in-STA-mode error path behavior
If a second scan trigger attempt fails in STA mode, the error path was
supposed to restore the old mode that was in use before changing to STA
mode. However, wpa_driver_nl80211_set_mode() changes drv->nlmode on
success, so the recovery path needs to use the saved old_mode value
instead.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-15 00:59:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cebee30f31 Add domain_match network profile parameter
This is similar with domain_suffix_match, but required a full match of
the domain name rather than allowing suffix match (subdomains) or
wildcard certificates.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-14 15:45:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d07d3fbda2 Add peer certificate alt subject name information to EAP events
A new "CTRL-EVENT-EAP-PEER-ALT depth=<i> <alt name>" event is now used
to provide information about server certificate chain alternative
subject names for upper layers, e.g., to make it easier to configure
constraints on the server certificate. For example:
CTRL-EVENT-EAP-PEER-ALT depth=0 DNS:server.example.com

Currently, this includes DNS, EMAIL, and URI components from the
certificates. Similar information is priovided to D-Bus Certification
signal in the new altsubject argument which is a string array of these
items.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-14 15:45:18 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dd5f902584 Get rid of a compiler warning
Commit e7d0e97bdb ('hostapd: Add vendor
specific VHT extension for the 2.4 GHz band') resulted in a compiler
warning regarding comparison between signed and unsigned integers at
least for 32-bit builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-14 01:38:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d29fa3a767 Extend VENDOR_ELEM parameters to cover non-P2P Association Request
The new VENDOR_ELEM value 13 can now be used to add a vendor element
into all (Re)Association Request frames, not just for P2P use cases like
the previous item was for.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-14 01:12:56 +02:00
Yanbo Li
e7d0e97bdb hostapd: Add vendor specific VHT extension for the 2.4 GHz band
This allows vendor specific information element to be used to advertise
support for VHT on 2.4 GHz band. In practice, this is used to enable use
of 256 QAM rates (VHT-MCS 8 and 9) on 2.4 GHz band.

This functionality is disabled by default, but can be enabled with
vendor_vht=1 parameter in hostapd.conf if the driver advertises support
for VHT on either 2.4 or 5 GHz bands.

Signed-off-by: Yanbo Li <yanbol@qti.qualcomm.com>
2015-01-14 00:59:22 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3e7f1c7980 GnuTLS: Add TLS event callbacks for chain success/failure and peer cert
This makes GnuTLS events match the ones provided when OpenSSL is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0eb2ed067f GnuTLS: Add support for OCSP stapling as a client
This allows ocsp=2 to be used with wpa_supplicant when built with GnuTLS
to request TLS status extension (OCSP stapling) to be used to validate
server certificate validity.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0e1bb94b91 GnuTLS: Verify that server certificate EKU is valid for a server
The server certificate will be rejected if it includes any EKU and none
of the listed EKUs is either TLS Web Server Authentication or ANY.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d4d1f5cb33 GnuTLS: Fix tls_disable_time_checks=1 processing
Certificate expiration is checked both within GnuTLS and in the
tls_gnutls.c implementation. The former was configured to use the
request to ignore time checks while the latter was not. Complete support
for this parameter by ignoring the internal expiration checks if
requested.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
594d1fc084 GnuTLS: Add support for private_key and client_cert as blobs
This allows private key and client certificate to be configured using
wpa_supplicant blobs instead of external files.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
79b1dd9aad GnuTLS: Fix DER encoding certificate parsing
It looks like GnuTLS may return success on
gnutls_certificate_set_x509_*() functions with GNUTLS_X509_FMT_PEM even
when trying to read DER encoded information. Reverse the order of
parsing attempts so that we start with DER and then move to PEM if
GnuTLS reports failure on DER parsing. This seems to be more reliable
way of getting errors reported and both cases can now be handled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1068bdb90c tests: Fix crypto module test build without EAP-FAST
Skip the EAP-FAST specific test cases if wpa_supplicant build is
configured not to include EAP-FAST support.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a16514516b Add "GET tls_library" to provide information on TLS library and version
This new wpa_supplicant and hostapd control interface command can be
used to determine which TLS library is used in the build and what is the
version of that library.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c3bb84b415 GnuTLS: Add event callbacks
This allows wpa_supplicant to provide more information about peer
certificate validation results to upper layers similarly to the
mechanism used with OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8ddcd6b9d4 GnuTLS: Add support for domain_suffix_match
This implementation uses GnuTLS function
gnutls_x509_crt_check_hostname(). It has a bit different rules regarding
matching (allows wildcards in some cases, but does not use suffix
matching) compared to the internal implementation used with OpenSSL.
However, these rules are sufficiently close to each other to be of
reasonable use for most cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4bc13bf709 GnuTLS: Check for any unknown verification failure
After having checked all known GNUTLS_CERT_* error cases that we care
about, check that no other errors have been indicated by
gnutls_certificate_verify_peers2() as a reason to reject negotiation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e0d431a515 GnuTLS: Add more debug prints for version and session status
Make the debug output more useful for determining whuch version of
GnuTLS was used and what was negotiated for the session.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
65ec7f4c12 GnuTLS: Move peer certificate validation into callback function
GnuTLS 2.10.0 added gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function() that can be
used to move peer certificate validation to an earlier point in the
handshake. Use that to get similar validation behavior to what was done
with OpenSSL, i.e., reject the handshake immediately after receiving the
peer certificate rather than at the completion of handshake.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:19:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7c8245798f GnuTLS: Remove support for versions older than 2.12.x
GnuTLS project has marked 2.12.x obsolete since January 2014. There is
not much need for maintaining support for obsolete versions of the
library, so drop all #if/#endif blocks targeting 2.x.y versions. In
practice, none of these were requiring 2.12.x version with x greater
than 0, so 2.12.x remains supported for now.

In addition, add newer version (GnuTLS 3.0.18 and newer) to fetch client
and server random from the session since the old method is not supported
by new GnuTLS versions and as such, gets removed with rest of the old
ifdef blocks.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-12 00:18:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e1d63f6aea GnuTLS: Remove old version number checks for 1.3.2
No one should be using GnuTLS versions older than 1.3.2 from 2006
anymore, so remove these unnecessary #if/#endif checks.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 11:13:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ae0a23a0ca GnuTLS: Remove GNUTLS_INTERNAL_STRUCTURE_HACK
This was needed with very old GnuTLS versions, but has not been needed,
or used, since GnuTLS 1.3.2 which was released in 2006. As such, there
is no need to maintain this code anymore and it is better to just clean
the source code by removing all the related code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 11:11:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
db4cf40b92 GnuTLS: Add support for ca_cert as a blob
This allows GnuTLS to be used with trusted CA certificate from
wpa_supplicant blob rather than an external certificate file.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 01:49:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
224104ddf6 TLS: Reject openssl_ciphers parameter in non-OpenSSL cases
This TLS configuration parameter is explicitly for OpenSSL. Instead of
ignoring it silently, reject any configuration trying to use it in
builds that use other options for TLS implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 01:35:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6dbbef9603 Define host_to_le32() for Windows builds
This define had been forgotten at some point in time and wpa_supplicant
compilation for Windows failed with some recently added code that
depended on this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:58:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7d28e46a6c Fix os_win32 build
Addition of os_memcmp_const() in commit
afc3c8b07f had forgotten to include
common.h into os_win32.c to get u8 defined.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:58:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0b402479bf Remove Network Security Service (NSS) support
NSS as a TLS/crypto library alternative was never completed and this
barely functional code does not even build with the current NSS version.
Taken into account that there has not been much interest in working on
this crypto wrapper over the years, it is better to just remove this
code rather than try to get it into somewhat more functional state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:58:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d16694761a schannel: Reject subject_match, altsubject_match, suffix_match
Validation of these parameters has not been implemented with schannel.
Instead of ignoring them silently, reject the configuration to avoid
giving incorrect impression of the parameters being used if
wpa_supplicant is built with schannel instead of the default OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:58:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
59051f8ecf TLS: Reject subject_match, altsubject_match, suffix_match
Validation of these parameters has not been implemented in the internal
TLS implementation. Instead of ignoring them silently, reject the
configuration to avoid giving incorrect impression of the parameters
being used if wpa_supplicant is built with the internal TLS
implementation instead of the default OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:37:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f8717ac8b3 GnuTLS: Reject subject_match, altsubject_match, suffix_match
Validation of these parameters has not been implemented with GnuTLS.
Instead of ignoring them silently, reject the configuration to avoid
giving incorrect impression of the parameters being used if
wpa_supplicant is built with GnuTLS instead of the default OpenSSL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:33:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e24aef10cf Fix a typo in domain_suffix_match documentation
Spell SubjectName correctly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:27:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
394b54732e Improve subject_match and domain_suffix_match documentation
These were already covered in both README-HS20 for credentials and in
header files for developers' documentation, but the copy in
wpa_supplicant.conf did not include all the details. In addition, add a
clearer note pointing at subject_match not being suitable for suffix
matching domain names; domain_suffix_match must be used for that.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-11 00:27:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8a42a076aa trace: Fix out-of-memory testing logic
data.function needs to be set for the return value to be of any use and
strcmp won't work with NULL pointer either. (CID 99907)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Stefan Tomanek
79cd993a62 Add address masks to BSSID lists
In many applications it is useful not just to enumerate a group of well
known access points, but to use a address/mask notation to match an
entire set of addresses (ca:ff:ee:00:00:00/ff:ff:ff:00:00:00).

This change expands the data structures used by MAC lists to include a
mask indicating the significant (non-masked) portions of an address and
extends the list parser to recognize mask suffixes.

Signed-off-by: Stefan Tomanek <stefan.tomanek@wertarbyte.de>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
21c74e8462 nl80211: Use a helper function to put mesh_id
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
85e1fad8a5 nl80211: Use a helper function for putting beacon interval
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6dfc55723d Remove mesh_ht_mode network block parameter
There should not be a mesh-specific mechanism for setting up channel
parameters since that will just result in duplicated code. IBSS, mesh,
and AP mode can use the same data structures and parameters for setting
up such parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f7e889fa2d mesh: Convert channel configuration to use common routines
Use struct hostapd_freq_params just like other modes do instead of
mesh-specific freq and ht_mode.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1fc4ab2367 nl80211: Move debug prints into nl80211_put_freq_params()
This way all callers can get the benefit of the same debug prints.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cae87abd13 nl80211: Add a helper function for putting basic rates
There is no need for maintaining two more or less identical copies of
this functionality.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
a828f626af Make check_40mhz_2g4 common
Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
fdd989d17a Make check_20mhz_bss common
Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
0e550fe496 Make check_40mhz_5g common
Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
6d5d098f77 Make get_pri_sec_chan() common
Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
514427437a Introduce common allowed_ht40_channel_pair()
This can be used from hostapd/wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
5f10b7f498 Use common hw_get_freq/hw_get_chan helpers in hostapd
Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
269dfe232b Introduce common hw features
Introduce wpa_supplicant/hostapd hw features.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
1830817ece IBSS: Add WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_HT_IBSS
Add WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_HT_IBSS driver feature flag. Some drivers could not
set this feature and next could fail when we will enable HT support for
IBSS with error message: nl80211: Join IBSS failed: ret=-22 (Invalid
argument).

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:53 +02:00
Bob Copeland
f3b8ad4d78 SAE: Implement retransmission timer
Add the t0 retransmission timer as specified by IEEE Std 802.11-2012,
11.3.8.4. This makes SAE much more likely to succeed in the case of lost
frames.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-01-10 17:35:52 +02:00
Bob Copeland
a206e2a175 SAE: Centralize function for sending initial COMMIT
When performing SAE authentication in mesh, one station may
initiate authentication by sending a COMMIT as soon as a peer
candidate is discovered. Previously we did this in mesh_rsn.c,
but this left some of the state initialization in a different
part of the code from the rest of the state machine, and we may
need to add other initializations here in the future, so move
that to a more central function.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2015-01-10 11:43:29 +02:00
Imre Vadasz
28c91ee124 bsd: Fix parsing of ieee80211req_scan_result on FreeBSD and DragonFly
On FreeBSD and DragonFly BSD, we additionally need to skip the
isr_meshid_len bytes of the MESH ID, to get the correct address for
copying the IE data.

The isr_meshid_len field was added in the FreeBSD svn revision r195618
in 2009, so I don't think we need to check the FreeBSD version here.

Signed-off-by: Imre Vadász <imre@vdsz.com>
2015-01-10 11:43:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
27d9701dea Fix a memory leak on WPA authenticator error path
wpa_auth->group needs to be freed if PMK cache setup fails.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-08 02:34:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c1c07dcb70 Fix hostapd interface addition error path
The local conf pointer needs to be cleared once it gets assigned to
hapd_iface to avoid double-free of the configuration data on error path.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-08 02:34:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a156ffda61 Add support for testing memory allocation failures
The new control interface command TEST_ALLOC_FAIL and GET_ALLOC_FAIL can
now be used to trigger memory allocation failures for testing purposes.
TEST_ALLOC_FAIL sets a failure conditions with
<count>:func[;func][;func]... string and GET_ALLOC_FAIL returns the
current state using the same format. Whenever an allocation is made with
a matching backtrace of calling functions, the count is decremented by
one and once zero is reached, the allocation is forced to fail.

Function names can be prefixed with either '=' or '?' to get different
matching behavior. '=' requires this specific function to be the next
one in the backtrace (i.e., do not skip any other functions in the list
which is the default behavior). '?' allows the function to be optionally
present in the backtrace.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
52a80583ba TDLS: Fix an interface addition error path
It is possible for wpa_tdls_teardown_peers() to be called with sm ==
NULL in case interface addition fails before the WPA state machine is
initialized.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-07 13:19:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3d2e2d5d63 trace: Fix compiler warning on 32-bit builds with bfd support
With CONFIG_WPA_TRACE_BFD, the type cast from void* to integer was
generating a compiler warning due to the target integer being larger in
size in case of 32-bit builds. Type case to bfd_hostptr_t instead of
directly to bfd_vma to avoid this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 18:30:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b9f6560f38 eloop: Fix WPA_TRACE tracking in case of realloc failure
The socket reference tracking entries need to be restored in case
os_realloc_array() fails when adding a new eloop socket.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 18:30:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e10422c025 Fix memory leak on hostapd BSS addition error path
The per-BSS configuration information needs to be freed if hostapd fails
to add a new interface for a BSS added with "ADD bss_config=..."
command.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 18:30:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2801659268 Fix hostapd initialization error path on allocation failure
If hostapd_alloc_bss_data() failed to allocate the struct hostapd_data
instance, dynamic interface addition path ended up trying to dereference
freed memory due to incorrect cleanup steps. Fix this by decrementing
the interface count when the newly added interface is removed. In
addition, make the setup more robust by clearing all changes within
hostapd_data_alloc() if any of the allocations fails.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 18:30:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d58ade2121 nl80211: Fix compilation with libnl 1.1 and 2.0
Unfortunately, libnl 3.0 has changed the API in a way that is not
backwards compatible by renaming nlmsg_len() to nlmsg_datalen() without
leaving the older nlmsg_len() defined. As such, there does not seem to
be any clean way of using this function without breaking the build with
some libnl versions. For now, replace this call with direct calculation
of the data length since it can be done with a simple one-liner that
compiles with all libnl versions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 18:30:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
51f3427019 crypto: Clear temporary stack buffers after use
This reduces possibility of exposure of private keys should something
get access to stack memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 02:49:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
77a2c3941e crypto: Clear temporary heap allocations before freeing
This reduces the time private keys may remain in heap memory after use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-06 02:49:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a15a7fcf69 DH: Clear memory explicitly on private key deinit
Remove any DH private key from heap memory after use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 18:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
77c45e2b35 Add wpabuf_clear_free() to allow clearing of freed memory
This can be useful when a wpabuf is used to store private data that
should not be left in heap after use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 18:02:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
59be78ef93 tests: Move SHA256 test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 17:34:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4b462a0226 tests: Move SHA1 test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 17:29:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a90c7d91a0 OpenSSL: Fix pbkdf2_sha1() wrapper
This was supposed to use the iterations parameter from the caller
instead of the hardcoded 4096. In practice, this did not have problems
for normal uses since that 4096 value was used in all cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 17:27:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
896e1b836f tests: Move MD5 test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 17:12:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
88fc0dca98 tests: Move ms_funcs test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 17:05:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5c0ff9f9a3 tests: Add some of the AES ECB mode test cases from CAVS 11.1
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 16:57:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1244408401 tests: Move AES key wrap/unwrap test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 16:35:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
477f83131f tests: Move AES-CBC test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 16:28:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e438fb0d3a tests: Move AES-128 EAX mode test cases into hwsim framework
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 16:24:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6c33962dd1 tests: Additional OMAC1-AES module test coverage
This verifies couple of corner cases with short vector entries in the
OMAC1-AES implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 16:15:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
304d40e904 tests: Move OMAC1-AES test cases into hwsim module tests
This makes sure the test cases are executed automatically with rest of
the hwsim tests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 16:02:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
942b75468d tests: Add module tests for AES-SIV
This moves the AES-SIV test case from tests/test-aes.c to be part of
wpa_supplicant module testing framework with a new
src/crypto/crypto_module_tests.c component. In addition, the second test
vector from RFC 5297 is also included for additional coverage.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 15:50:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f6ebbcf62a AES-SIV: Make aes_s2v() static
This function is not used outside aes-siv.c. In addition, include the
aes_siv.h header to make sure that functions get declared consistently.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 15:22:36 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dcf8fbc058 nl80211: Simplify event processing error paths
These are practically unreachable code since cfg80211 fills in the
required attributes or does not send the event. Keep the checks in
place, but minimize the extra code in wpa_supplicant/hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 13:40:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
38751d8bd5 nl80211: Remove cfg80211 state mismatch workaround for authentication
cfg80211 dropped support for tracking BSS authentication state and
setting NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED in 'cfg80211: stop tracking
authenticated state' three years ago (starting in Linux 3.4). As such,
this workaround code in wpa_supplicant cannot be reached anymore. There
is no real need for maintaining it for older kernels either, since there
are other ways of detecting and working around state mismatches with the
actual authentication operations failing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 12:21:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
64ae244763 nl80211: Check support for rekey offload on first use
While there is no explicit driver capability advertisement for this in
nl80211, the EOPNOTSUPP response can be interpreted as a clear
indication of NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD not being supported. Check
for that and don't try to offload keys again if the driver has not use
for them.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-05 12:00:09 +02:00
Ilan Peer
86056fea63 nl80211: Handle MAC address randomization in scan/sched_scan
1. Process supported driver capabilities.
2. Populate scan request with MAC address randomization data

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-04 23:06:31 +02:00
Ilan Peer
ff23ed221d driver: Add definitions for MAC address randomization in scan
1. Add parameters to the scan command to allow MAC address
   randomization during scan and scheduled scan.
2. Add capability bits to publish MAC address randomization support
   in scan and scheduled scan.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2015-01-04 21:46:38 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
72b2605f15 nl80211: Pass TDLS channel-switch start/stop params to kernel
The kernel-driver/firmware are responsible for performing periodic
switches to the target channel with the given peer. Propagate all TDLS
channel switching related information to kernel.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 21:46:37 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
6b90deae4d TDLS: Propagate enable/disable channel-switch commands to driver
The supplicant code does not try to control the actual channel of the
radio at any point. It simply passes the target peer and channel
parameters to the driver. It's the driver's responsibility to
periodically initiate TDLS channel-switch operations when TDLS
channel-switching is enabled.

Allow enable/disable operations to be invoked via the control interface.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 20:30:11 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
d9d3b78c67 TDLS: Track TDLS channel switch prohibition in BSS
Mark an appropriate sm flag when TDLS switch is prohibited by the AP.
Populate the flag upon association with the AP.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:59:31 +02:00
Arik Nemtsov
4daa572925 TDLS: Add channel-switch capability flag
Propagate a driver TDLS channel-switch support bit from nl80211 to
TDLS code.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:59:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ca16586afe Sync with wireless-testing.git include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h
This brings in nl80211 definitions as of 2014-11-26.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-04 18:59:31 +02:00
Avraham Stern
730a0d16bf nl80211: Always register management frames handler
If registering WMM-AC ADDTS response action frame or WMM-AC DELTS
action frame fails, the management frame handler is not being
registered. This results with a segmentation fault when trying to
unsubscribe the handler when the interface is removed.
Fix it by always registering the handler and just returning a negative
value to note that the action frame could not be registered.

This fixes an issue introduced in the commit
dfa8787833 ('nl80211: Implement
add_ts/del_ts ops').

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2015-01-04 18:28:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4e8f31e2ef doc: Extend driver.h documentation
This documents some more parts of the driver wrapper interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-03 18:24:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bbd89bfca0 nl80211: Clear nlmsg payload with keys before freeing
This reduces the time possible keys could remain in heap memory. Couple
of the nl80211 messages include keys (TK for normal ciphers and
KCK/KEK/PMK for various offloading cases).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-03 01:15:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f2535da879 nl80211: Note linux_set_iface_flags() failure in debug log
There was one final remaining linux_set_iface_flags() call that did not
check the result. This specific one does not really matter much, but
anyway, be more consistent by checking the result and log any error in
debug log. (CID 74146)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2015-01-02 22:56:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8509fb5cce D-Bus: Fix memory leak on P2P GO WPSVendorExtensions
It was possible to add WPS vendor extensions through the D-Bus
WPSVendorExtensions setter, but these extensions were not freed when the
P2P GO was stopped or when replacing previously configured extensions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-30 22:22:39 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4e70bbf1c6 SAE: Clear keys from memory on disassociation
There is no need to keep temporary keys in memory beyond the end of the
association, so explicitly clear any SAE buffers that can contain keys
as soon as such keys are not needed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 20:00:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
fbfc974c6c Clear GTK from memory as soon as it is not needed anymore
It was possible for the decrypted EAPOL-Key Key Data field to remain in
heap after the temporary buffer was freed. Explicitly clear that buffer
before freeing it to minimize the time GTK remains in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7d711541dc Clear TK part of PTK after driver key configuration
There is no need for wpa_supplicant to maintain a copy of the TK part of
PTK after this has been configured to the driver, so clear that from
heap memory and only maintain KEK and KCK during association to allow
additional EAPOL-Key handshakes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7193254456 Clear temporary keys from WPA supplicant state machine when not needed
PMK and PTK are not needed in the supplicant state machine after
disassociation since core wpa_supplicant will reconfigure them for the
next association. As such, clear these from heap in
wpa_sm_notify_disassoc() to reduce time and number of places storing key
material in memory. In addition, clear FT keys in case of
CONFIG_IEEE80211R=y build (sm->xxkey stored a copy of PSK in case of
FT-PSK).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 19:44:51 +02:00
Paul Stewart
de27bc7673 hostapd: Set stdout line-buffered
If hostapd will use stdout for debugging, set stdout to be line
buffered in case its output is redirected to a file. This allows
incremental output to be viewed immediately instead of at the file
buffering interval.

Signed-hostap: Paul Stewart <pstew@chromium.org>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
David Woodhouse
a642a52b17 OpenSSL: Do not require a PIN for PKCS#11
It isn't mandatory. If we need one and it's not present, the ENGINE will
try asking for it. Make sure it doesn't actually let an OpenSSL UI loose,
since we don't currently capture those.

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
David Woodhouse
96955192b3 OpenSSL: Automatically enable PKCS#11 engine where it's needed
It needs to be available to ENGINE_by_id(), which in my case means it
needs to be /usr/lib64/openssl/engines/libpkcs11.so. But that's a system
packaging issue. If it isn't there, it will fail gracefully enough with:

ENGINE: engine pkcs11 not available [error:25066067:DSO support routines:DLFCN_LOAD:could not load the shared library]
TLS: Failed to set TLS connection parameters
EAP-TLS: Failed to initialize SSL.

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
David Woodhouse
ddda627618 OpenSSL: Load dynamic ENGINE unconditionally
This means that if the PKCS#11 engine is installed in the right place
in the system, it'll automatically be invoked by ENGINE_by_id("pkcs11")
later, and things work without explictly configuring pkcs11_engine_path.

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
David Woodhouse
01b0d1d5c1 OpenSSL: Automatically handle PKCS#11 URIs in private_key, ca/client_cert
If these start with "pkcs11:" then they are PKCS#11 URIs. These Just Work
in the normal private_key/ca_cert/client_cert configuration fields when
built with GnuTLS; make it work that way with OpenSSL too.

(Yes, you still need to explicitly set engine=1 and point to the engine,
but I'll work on that next...)

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
David Woodhouse
3d268b8d19 OpenSSL: Do not require private key to come from PKCS#11
There's no reason I shouldn't be able to use PKCS#11 for just the CA cert,
or even the client cert, while the private key is still from a file.

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
David Woodhouse
5c8ab0d49c OpenSSL: Allow pkcs11_module_path to be NULL
New versions of engine_pkcs11 will automatically use the system's
p11-kit-proxy.so to make the globally-configured PKCS#11 tokens available
by default. So invoking the engine without an explicit module path is
not an error.

Older engines will fail but gracefully enough, so although it's still an
error in that case there's no need for us to catch it for ourselves.

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
010fa245bd Add QUIET=1 option for make
This can be used to reduce verbosity for build messages.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-29 15:49:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
49e3eea8d9 Avoid -Wshadow warnings from older gcc versions
It looks like gcc 4.8.2 would warn about these with -Wshadow, but 4.6.3
did.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-26 13:21:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a193231dfb Clean up debug prints to use wpa_printf()
This converts most of the remaining perror() and printf() calls from
hostapd and wpa_supplicant to use wpa_printf().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-26 13:20:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cad9b88be2 Fix CONFIG_OS=none build
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff013b94ca Fix CONFIG_OS=internal build
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
David Woodhouse
7d9286d3e7 Support private_key_passwd for GnuTLS (3.1.11+)
It's possible to jump through hoops to support it in older versions too,
but that seems a little unnecessary at this point.

Signed-off-by: David Woodhouse <David.Woodhouse@intel.com>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cbe23ffd6d GnuTLS: Get rid of warnings about deprecated typedef names
'_t' suffix for gnutls_session and gnutls_transport_ptr was added in
GnuTLS 1.1.11 over ten years ago and the more recent versions of GnuTLS
have started forcing compiler warnings from the old names. Move to the
new names and don't bother about backwards compatibility with older
versions taken into account how long ago this change happened in GnuTLS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
36f0cf3774 privsep: Fix compilation due to associate() parameter updates
struct wpa_driver_associate_params moved to using struct
hostapd_freq_params instead of just frequency. Need to update wpa_priv
to do same.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
eae3df7ee4 P2P: Fix memory leak on GO startup failure path
Some of the struct hostapd_data variables get initialized with allocated
memory in the P2P GO case even before hapd->started has been set to 1.
As such, hostapd_free_hapd_data() needs to free these even if
!hapd->stated.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-25 16:37:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
40e7639600 nl80211: Check if_indextoname() return value for bridge events
It would be at least theoretically possible for the bridge netdev to
have disappeared at the time hostapd processes the RTM newlink/dellink
message. As such, it is better to verify that if_indextoname() actually
returned success before printing the bridge ifname in debug. In
addition, there is not much point trying to add the bridge ifindex into
the list of own ifindexes in case the interface has already been
removed, so skip that part as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-23 19:43:24 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3a322496f9 mesh: Delay Authentication frame process with no_auto_peer
There is a possible race condition between receiving the
NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE event and the Authentication frame from the peer.
Previously, if the Authentication frame RX event was indicated first,
that frame got dropped silently. Now, this frame is still dropped, but a
copy of it is stored and the frame gets processed on the following
NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE event if that is received for the same peer within
two seconds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-23 13:44:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0acc2c809d HT: More robust 20/40 coex Action frame parsing
Commit 587d60d2b7 ('Add AP mode support
for HT 20/40 co-ex Action frame') added processing of co-ex report, but
did not include proper bounds checking or IE type checking for the
payload. Furthermore, this was not ready for the possible extensibility
of the 20/40 BSS Coexistence element.

Fix these by checking IE ids for both elements and doing more
apprioriate bounds checking for the element lengths to avoid potentially
reading beyond the frame buffer. Though, the event receive buffer in
both libnl and driver_nl80211_monitor.c is sufficiently large to make it
very unlikely that the maximum read of about 260 bytes beyond the end of
the Action frame would really have any chances of hitting the end of the
memory buffer, so the practical effect of missing bounds checking would
have been possibly accepting an invalid report frame and moving to 20
MHz channel unnecessarily.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-22 21:54:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2a32ad66da HT: Fix 20/40 coex Action frame parsing
Commit 5ce3ae4c8f tried to clean up
fetching a pointer to the action code field, but it forgot to add
IEEE80211_HDRLEN to the pointer. This resulted in the coex report
elements being read from too early in the frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-22 20:41:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ce20a3702c nl80211: Remove practically unused process_drv_event()
This was used in the past, but all the event processing is now either
through process_global_event() or process_bss_event().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-22 16:12:11 +02:00
Masashi Honma
4b4093686b mesh: Make maximum number of peer links configurable
Maximum number of peer links is maximum number of connecting mesh peers
at the same time. This value is 0..255 based on the
dot11MeshNumberOfPeerings range.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:52:31 +02:00
Masashi Honma
9c58c5f72c mesh: Make beacon interval configurable
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-21 23:38:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
422ba11e30 Flush WPS registrar state on wpa_supplicant FLUSH command
This helps hwsim test cases by avoiding undesired state from previously
executed test cases affecting following tests.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-21 17:47:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8779ac8a67 EAP-IKEv2: Fix a typo in a debug message
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-21 13:19:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bb68a6e3cc EAP-IKEv2 peer: Fix fragmentation reassembly
ret->ignore needs to be cleared to FALSE when sending fragment ack
message to avoid ignoring the fragment.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-21 00:48:24 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8e5c1ec32f EAP-IKEv2: Add explicit limit for maximum message length
This avoids accepting unnecessarily large memory allocations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-21 00:25:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5ef8e39fa7 nl80211: Fix interface-in-different-bridge case
The local ifindex list needs to be updated only if the current bridge
interface is the correct one. If hostapd is going to move the interface
to another bridge, the old bridge ifindex must not be added. In
addition, when removing the bridge interface on deinit, it may need to
be set down to allow bridge removal.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-20 21:00:08 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
666e508ccf nl80211: Fix cfg80211 workaround for IBSS join
The interface was incorrectly changed to station mode between the two
IBSS join requests and that made the second attempt fail. Remove that
undesired mode clearing from this special case of IBSS leave sequence.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-20 19:35:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
13a3a20dfe Fix wpa_key_mgmt and wpa_pairwise configuration for non-WPA
These hostapd configuration parameter was left at the default values
(WPA-PSK/TKIP) even for cases where WPA was disabled. While these
parameters are not really used much in non-WPA cases, they do get used
for one corner case in nl80211 configuration to disable encryption of
EAPOL frames in IEEE 802.1X WEP case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-20 18:44:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
533fe09b78 nl80211: Fix no-encrypt for IEEE 802.1X WEP EAPOL
Commit 9f12614b8c ('nl80211: Do not
encrypt IEEE 802.1X WEP EAPOL') tried to use
NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT to disable encryption of EAPOL
frames for WEP IEEE 802.1X. However, it used incorrect key management
suite (IEEE 802.1X with WPA/WPA2 while the non-WPA version is needed
here). Consequently, the no-encrypt flag was never set to the driver
(WPA/WPA2 cases do not meet the WEP as pairwise criteria).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-20 17:35:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1033315fbe nl80211: Remove send_and_recv_msgs_global() wrapper
There was only a single user for this and calling send_and_recv()
directly is as simple as using this wrapper.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-20 15:45:28 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bdf5ccb264 nl80211: Remove unnecessary function declarations
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-20 15:37:16 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
afa2ffb413 SAE: Check Status Code in Authentication frames
While other authentication algorithms mark Status Code as being Reserved
in the case of the transaction number 1, SAE does not. Check that the
Status Code indicates success before creating SAE state. In addition,
fix the mesh anti-clogging token request parsing on big endian CPUs.

Transaction number 2 (confirm) can also have non-zero Status Code to
report an error. Those should be processed, but not replied to with yet
another error message. This could happen in mesh case. Avoid a loop of
error messages by dropping the non-success case without additional
response.

In addition, don't reply to unknown transaction numbers if the status
code is non-zero. This avoids a loop of error messages if an invalid
frame where to be injected (or unlikely corruption were to occur).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-15 00:06:56 +02:00
Masashi Honma
5b78493f3b mesh: Add mesh interface creation command for mesh gate
The mesh gate is used to bridge (or route) between mesh network and
another network. For example, mesh gate acts as router between mesh
network and IEEE 802.11 BSS network.

This command makes a virtual mesh interface to be used for mesh gate.

This command expects to be used like this.

wpa_cli -i wlan0 MESH_INTERFACE_ADD ifname=mesh0
wpa_cli -i mesh0 add_network
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 ssid '"commell_2X_mmm"'
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 mode 5
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 frequency 2412
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 key_mgmt SAE
wpa_cli -i mesh0 set_network 0 psk '"01234567"'
wpa_cli -i mesh0 mesh_group_add 0
wpa_cli -i wlan0 mesh_group_remove mesh0

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-12-14 23:27:43 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bd0b620371 SAE: Add sae_group to AP/mesh mode STA ctrl_iface data
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 20:14:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7781da6b2b Remove unused find_first_bit()
This was used only for the VHT capability checks for determining bit
offset for right shift. That was replaced with a constant defines since
there is no need to calculate this at runtime.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 19:01:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9ae52e7034 Clean up VHT configuration validation
There is no need to use runtime call to find_first_bit() to determine
shift amount for a constant integer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 19:00:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b0f33467a5 Clean up VHT override max A-MPDU override calculation
There is no need to use runtime call to find_first_bit() to determine
shift amount for a constant integer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 18:48:59 +02:00
Jörg Krause
33c7eb810a wext: Fix musl build error
Building wpa_supplicant with the musl C library fails since musl does
not define type names such as '__uint32_t'. To support building
wpa_supplicant with the musl C library use the integer types declared in
the ISO C standard header file <stdint.h>.

Signed-off-by: Jörg Krause <jkrause@posteo.de>
2014-12-14 18:05:32 +02:00
Rafał Miłecki
7c4027f604 nl80211: Report new station / assoc event for the correct BSS
drv->ctx always points to the first BSS and we should report event using
BSS related to the interface we got NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION from.
This fixes STA association for drivers using NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION and
multiple virtual interfaces.

Before:
nl80211: Drv Event 19 (NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) received for wlan0-1 (ifindex:7)
nl80211: New station 02:00:00:00:01:00
wlan0: STA 02:00:00:00:01:00 IEEE 802.11: associated

After:
nl80211: Drv Event 19 (NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION) received for wlan0-1 (ifindex:7)
nl80211: New station 02:00:00:00:01:00
wlan0-1: STA 02:00:00:00:01:00 IEEE 802.11: associated

This is not applicable to the cases where authentication (AP SME & MLME)
is in hostapd and hostapd_assoc_cb() instead of hostapd_notif_assoc()
handles BSS selection.

Signed-off-by: Rafał Miłecki <zajec5@gmail.com>
2014-12-14 17:29:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ce460118a8 ERP: Drop ERP keys on failure on the peer
This allows recovery through fallback to full EAP authentication if the
server rejects us, e.g., due to having dropped ERP state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 15:47:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2c6411edd0 ERP: Add ERP_FLUSH for hostapd
This can be used to drop any pending ERP key from both the internal AP
authentication server and RADIUS server use of hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-14 15:47:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a0a34d536e nl80211: Add rrm_flags to STATUS-DRIVER
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-12 21:09:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0629eeb490 RRM: Add AP mode minimal advertisement support for testing
The new hostapd.conf radio_measurements parameter can now be used to
configure a test build to advertise support for radio measurements with
neighbor report enabled. There is no real functionality that would
actually process the request, i.e., this only for the purpose of minimal
STA side testing for now.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-12 20:45:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
774d414513 Fix AP IE in EAPOL-Key 3/4 for WPA + FT combination
Previously, only WPA + WPA2 was covered. If FT is enabled in addition to
WPA, MDIE is included in the buffer between RSN and WPA elements. The
previous version ended up leaving only the MDIE after having skipped RSN
element. Fix this to skip MDIE as well to leave only WPA IE regardless
of whether FT is enabled in AP configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-12 14:03:36 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
72c5c289fb Add text names for number of the key_mgmt values
This completes STATUS command key_mgmt output for the missing values,
like SAE.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-12 13:40:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2961bfa8e1 Remove unused send_eapol() driver op
The send_eapol() callback was used by driver_test.c, but with that
removed, there is no remaining users of the alternative EAPOL frame
transmitting mechanism in wpa_supplicant, i.e., all remaining driver
interfaces use l2_packet instead. Remove the send_eapol() to get rid of
unused code.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-11 15:40:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6a31a31da1 OpenSSL: Simplify EAP-FAST peer workaround
Commit d4913c585e ('OpenSSL: Fix EAP-FAST
peer regression') introduced a workaround to use a new SSL_CTX instance
set for TLSv1_method() when using EAP-FAST. While that works, it is
unnecessarily complex since there is not really a need to use a separate
SSL_CTX to be able to do that. Instead, simply use SSL_set_ssl_method()
to update the ssl_method for the SSL instance. In practice, this commit
reverts most of the tls_openssl.c changes from that earlier commit and
adds that single call into tls_connection_set_params() based on EAP-FAST
flag.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-09 23:55:41 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b90d064f1a Add tls_session_reused=<0/1> into EAP peer TLS status
This can be used to determine whether the last TLS-based EAP
authentication instance re-used a previous session (e.g., TLS session
resumption or EAP-FAST session ticket).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-09 23:41:09 +02:00
Chet Lanctot
15badebd47 nl80211: Add QCA vendor specific query of device/driver features
This commit introduces a QCA vendor command that allows interrogation of
the vendor-specific features supported by the device/driver. Currently
the only defined feature is the ability to offload key management.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-09 21:08:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d4913c585e OpenSSL: Fix EAP-FAST peer regression
Commit 35efa2479f ('OpenSSL: Allow TLS
v1.1 and v1.2 to be negotiated by default') changed from using
TLSv1_method() to SSLv23_method() to allow negotiation of TLS v1.0,
v1.1, and v1.2.

Unfortunately, it looks like EAP-FAST does not work with this due to
OpenSSL not allowing ClientHello extensions to be configured with
SSL_set_session_ticket_ext() when SSLv23_method() is used. Work around
this regression by initiating a separate SSL_CTX instance for EAP-FAST
phase 1 needs with TLSv1_method() while leaving all other EAP cases
using TLS to work with the new default that allows v1.1 and v1.2 to be
negotiated. This is not ideal and will hopefully get fixed in the future
with a new OpenSSL method, but until that time, this can be used allow
other methods use newer TLS versions while still allowing EAP-FAST to be
used even if it remains to be constraint to TLS v1.0 only.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-09 16:57:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c1f5bcb96f TLS: Add new cipher suites to tls_get_cipher()
This fixes EAP-FAST server side issues for anonymous provisioning when
using the internal TLS implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-09 16:57:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c25addb156 OpenSSL: Remove support for the old EAP-FAST interface
Commit f5fa824e9a ('Update OpenSSL 0.9.8
patch for EAP-FAST support') changed the OpenSSL 0.9.8 patch to support
the new API that was introduced in OpenSSL 1.0.0 for EAP-FAST. As such,
there should be no valid users of the old API anymore and tls_openssl.c
can be cleaned up to use only the new API.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-09 16:57:05 +02:00
Xiaofei Shen
f68e86a4d6 MACsec: Update protect frames and replay on reauthentication
Some cases like ifconfig down/up may require MACsec restart. To make
sure the appropriate protect frames and replay parameters get configured
in cases where the interface was down, set these parameters from KaY
configuration to the driver before creating a new transmit SC. This
allows MACsec functionality to recover automatically on such restart.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-09 16:56:10 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
36b5c3335a P2P: Check Invitation Response dialog token match for resend case
Commit ac330cfd87 ('P2P: Reinvite with
social operation channel if no common channels') introduced a mechamisn
to reinvite a peer during a persistent group reinvocation from a GO with
a different operating channel proposal. This mechanism can fail if the
inviting device (GO) ends up getting a retransmitted, duplicated
Invitation Response frame processed second time while waiting for the
response to the retried Invitation Request (using one of the social
channels as the operating channel). IEEE 802.11 duplicate frame
detection mechanisms are supposed to prevent this type of sequence, but
not all drivers support those rules properly for pre-association frames,
including P2P Public Action frames.

Work around this issue by checking that the dialog token in the
Invitation Response frame matches the one from the last Invitation
Request if the special invitation retry mechanism is used. This is safer
to do now than to enable dialog token matching for all invitation cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-09 16:26:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1f90dfd2cd nl80211: Add frame control and sequence control field in RX frame debug
This makes it easier to debug issues related to duplicated management
frames on receive path.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-09 01:19:20 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4bd7195466 nl80211: Try to unmask 11b rates again on next connection request
It is possible for unmasking of 11b rates to fail if a P2P group is
terminated while the netdev is down (e.g., due to rfkill block). This
could result in the 11b TX rates being left masked for non-P2P
operations. This would be particularly unfortunate for channel 14 use
since OFDM rates are not allowed on channel 14 and only OFDM rates were
configured P2P. This issue showed up, e.g., when running hwsim test case
rfkill_autogo followed by ap_wps_conf_chan14.

It may be possible to allow the failed operation in cfg80211/mac80211,
but it looks better to work around this on wpa_supplicant side as well.
Try to unmask the 11b rates again on the next connection request if the
rate unmasking operation had failed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-08 16:10:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3e208481b5 nl80211: Add more debug prints for 11b rate disabling and re-enabling
This makes it easier to debug issues related to TX rate masking for P2P
use cases (and unmasking for non-P2P).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-08 16:01:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
aaadd72733 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - more checks
Add more os_snprintf() result validation checks.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1f102d3bb0 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - manual
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() for cases that were note covered by spatch and
semantic patches.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7bdd8981f7 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - automatic 2
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() where the comparison was 'res > size' instead of
'res >= size'. These changes were done automatically with spatch using
the following semantic patch:

@@
identifier E1;
expression E2,E3,E4,E5,E6;
statement S1;
@@

(
  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  int E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else if (E6)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = 0;
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else if (E6) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  }
)
? os_free(E4);
- if (E1 < 0 || \( E1 > E3 \| (size_t) E1 > E3 \| E1 > (int) E3 \))
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d85e1fc8a5 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - automatic 1
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() where the exact rule used in os_snprintf_error() was
used. These changes were done automatically with spatch using the
following semantic patch:

@@
identifier E1;
expression E2,E3,E4,E5,E6;
statement S1;
@@

(
  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  int E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
|
  if (E5)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else if (E6)
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  else
	E1 = 0;
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else if (E6) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	return -1;
  }
|
  if (E5) {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  } else {
	...
	E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
  }
)
? os_free(E4);
- if (E1 < 0 || \( E1 >= E3 \| (size_t) E1 >= E3 \| (unsigned int) E1 >= E3 \| E1 >= (int) E3 \))
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a80ba67a26 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - success case
This converts os_snprintf() result validation cases to use
os_snprintf_error() in cases where success condition was used to execute
a step. These changes were done automatically with spatch using the
following semantic patch:

@@
expression E1,E2,E3;
statement S1;
@@

  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
- if (\( E1 >= 0 \| E1 > 0 \) && \( (size_t) E1 < E3 \| E1 < (int) E3 \| E1 < E3 \))
+ if (!os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
  S1

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a9aaacbb50 Check os_snprintf() result more consistently - maximum length
This adds verification of os_snprintf() result against the maximum
buffer length. These changes were done automatically with spatch
using the following semantic patch:

@@
expression E1,E2,E3;
statement S1;
@@

  E1 = os_snprintf(E2, E3, ...);
- if (\( E1 < 0 \| E1 <= 0 \))
+ if (os_snprintf_error(E3, E1))
(
  S1
|
{ ... }
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0047306bc9 Add os_snprintf_error() helper
This can be used to check os_snprintf() return value more consistently.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
89b48f7b95 Use os_zalloc() instead of os_malloc() and os_memset()
Automatically updated with spatch and the following semantic patch:

@@
expression X;
expression E1;
statement S;
@@

- X = os_malloc(E1);
+ X = os_zalloc(E1);
(
  if (X == NULL) {
	...
  }
- os_memset(X, 0, E1);
|
  if (X == NULL)
	S
- os_memset(X, 0, E1);
)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
faebdeaa9e Use os_calloc() instead of os_zalloc()
Automatic changes with spatch using the following semantic patch:

@@
constant C;
type T;
@@

- os_zalloc(C*sizeof(T))
+ os_calloc(C,sizeof(T))

@@
expression E;
type T;
@@

- os_zalloc((E)*sizeof(T))
+ os_calloc(E,sizeof(T))

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
80d5a3db9a WPS: Start EAPOL immediately even without WPA on WPS association
Previously, the immediate EAPOL authenticator startup was scheduled
without having received EAPOL-Start only for the case where WPA/WPA2 was
enabled. This can be extended to speed up non-WPA/WPA2 cases as well if
the STA includes WPS IE in Association Request frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:42:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ff1dd3e9a1 base64: Try to avoid static analyzer warning (part 2)
Shift right on unsigned char limits the value to 0..63 which is within
bounds for base64_table[]. Anyway, some static analyzers do not seem to
understand that. See if an otherwise unnecessary masking gets rid of
false warnings. (CID 62858)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-08 11:07:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
cdbc0baac6 base64: Try to avoid static analyzer warning
Shift right on unsigned char limits the value to 0..63 which is within
bounds for base64_table[]. Anyway, some static analyzers do not seem to
understand that. See if an otherwise unnecessary masking gets rid of
false warnings. (CID 62858)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 19:26:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7d04364104 TLS: Reorder length bounds checking to avoid static analyzer warning
For some reason, "pos + len > end" is not clear enough, but "len > end -
pos" is recognized. Use that to get rid of a false positive from a
static analyzer (CID 72697).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 18:36:02 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
41f480005f EAP-SIM DB: Make recv() null termination easier for static analyzers
For some reason, the previous version was not understood to be null
terminating the buffer from recv(). It was doing this fine, though. Try
to use a bit more simpler design in hopes of getting static analyzers to
understand this. (CID 72702)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 18:35:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8105821b39 Replace send_ft_action() driver_op with send_action()
This reduced number of unnecessarily duplicated driver interface
callback functions for sending Action frames by using the more generic
send_action() instead of FT specific send_ft_action().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 18:13:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
477af8f869 nl80211: Move scanning related functionality to a separate file
This helps in making the still overly large driver_nl80211.c somewhat
more manageable.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:59:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
71f1d1e54d hostapd: Fix memory leak on dynamic add-BSS error path
If "ADD bss_config=" command failed in driver_init() or
hostapd_setup_interface(), some of the allocated resources were not
freed properly.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:42:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3f63614f18 nl80211: Clean up nl80211_scan_common() to use nl80211_cmd_msg()
This helper function had not used the nl80211_set_iface_id() helper, but
there is no reason why it couldn't re-use the same helper as other
places using nl80211_cmd_msg().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:18:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
95376e1a99 nl80211: Use nl80211_iface_msg() helper
Use the helper function to replace places that use nlmsg_alloc(),
nl80211_cmd(), and ifindex.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:18:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
13f83980f0 nl80211: Use nl80211_bss_msg() helper
Use the helper function to replace places that use nlmsg_alloc(),
nl80211_cmd(), and either bss->ifindex or if_nametoindex(bss->ifname).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:18:46 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a3249fdfb8 nl80211: Use nl80211_cmd_msg() for P2P Device operations
bss->wdev_id_set is set for the non-detdev P2P Device, so
nl80211_cmd_msg() can be used as-is for these cases as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:17:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9725b78421 nl80211: Use nl80211_drv_msg() helper
Use the helper function to replace places that use nlmsg_alloc(),
nl80211_cmd(), and drv->ifindex.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 17:17:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
350acc354d nl80211: Move nl80211_set_iface_id() next its only remaining user
This function was in a bit strange location between struct family_data
and family_handler() definitions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 16:41:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
56f77852e5 nl80211: Use the new nl80211_cmd_msg() helper
This removes duplicated code for building nl80211 commands for a BSS.
This commit handles the functions that were already using
nl80211_set_iface_id().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 16:41:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
07c7757cb1 nl80211: Add nl80211_*_msg() helpers
These new functions can be used to both allocate and build a header for
most nl80211 commands.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 16:41:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a862e4a38f nl80211: Continue getting rid of NLA_PUT* macro use
This gets rid of more NLA_PUT* macro uses in nl80211 to reduce the
number of functions that depend on the hidden behavior of jumping to the
nla_put_failure label.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:50:15 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9589a91e0e nl80211: Get rid of NLA_PUT* macro use in capability checking
This gets rid of NLA_PUT* macro use in checking nl80211 capabilities to
reduce the number of functions that depend on the hidden behavior of
jumping to the nla_put_failure label.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:18:38 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f27f1644a8 PCSC: Make AID copying easier for static analyzers
Use a separate pointer and length field instead of trying to copy from a
struct field that has only part of the full buffer available.
(CID 68115)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:16:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c397eff828 Make GTK length validation easier to analyze
Bounds checking for gd->gtk_len in wpa_supplicant_check_group_cipher()
was apparently too complex for some static analyzers. Use a local
variable and a more explicit validation step to avoid false report.
(CID 62864)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:16:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
369d07afc1 FT: Make aes_wrap() call easier to analyze
Using aes_wrap() to initialize a data structure seemed to be too much
for some static analyzers to understand. Make it obvious that the target
is not just the single struct member. (CID 68111)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:16:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7696760388 FT: Make aes_unwrap() calls easier to analyze
Using aes_unwrap() to initialize a data structure seemed to be too much
for some static analyzers to understand. Make it obvious that the target
is initialized and that the target is not just the single struct member.
In addition, clean up the design to avoid removal of const with a
typecast. (CID 68112, CID 68134, CID 68135, CID 68136)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:16:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a6306bcc92 P2P: Split p2p_channels_union() into two functions
The separate p2p_channels_union_inplace() makes the function easier for
static analyzers to see that the result buffer is always initialized.
(CID 74494)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-06 12:16:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5085ffb8f8 hostapd: Fix HT40 determination for ACS offload
Commit 16689c7cfc ('hostapd: Allow ACS to
be offloaded to the driver') used incorrect operator to determine
whether HT40 was configured. Fix that to mask the ht_capab bit
correctly. (CID 77286)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-05 01:08:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
56b352ec58 ERP: Avoid a static analyzer warning on uninitialized emsk_len
This was not really a real issue since bin_clear_free() would not use
the emsk_len argument when emsk is NULL as it would be on the path where
emsk_len has not been initilized. Anyway, it is better to get rid of the
warning.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-05 00:33:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
65d9a5e254 ERP: Add wpa_supplicant ERP_FLUSH ctrl_iface command
This can be used to flush all the ERP keys.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:16:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
02a8d45ace ERP: Add support for ERP on EAP peer
Derive rRK and rIK on EAP peer if ERP is enabled. The new wpa_supplicant
network configuration parameter erp=1 can now be used to configure the
EAP peer to derive EMSK, rRK, and rIK at the successful completion of an
EAP authentication method. This functionality is not included in the
default build and can be enabled with CONFIG_ERP=y.

If EAP authenticator indicates support for re-authentication protocol,
initiate this with EAP-Initiate/Re-auth and complete protocol when
receiving EAP-Finish/Re-auth.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:16:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d3bddd8b84 ERP: Add support for ERP on EAP server and authenticator
Derive rRK and rIK on EAP server if ERP is enabled and use these keys to
allow EAP re-authentication to be used and to derive rMSK.

The new hostapd configuration parameter eap_server_erp=1 can now be used
to configure the integrated EAP server to derive EMSK, rRK, and rIK at
the successful completion of an EAP authentication method. This
functionality is not included in the default build and can be enabled
with CONFIG_ERP=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:16:27 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e2ee327b19 ERP: Add TV/TLV parser
This is needed for ERP implementation on both the server/authenticator
and peer side.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:08:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0087061de7 ERP: Add HMAC-SHA256 KDF (RFC 5295)
This is needed for ERP key derivation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:08:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2a5156a66c ERP: Add optional EAP-Initiate/Re-auth-Start transmission
hostapd can now be configured to transmit EAP-Initiate/Re-auth-Start
before EAP-Request/Identity to try to initiate ERP. This is disabled by
default and can be enabled with erp_send_reauth_start=1 and optional
erp_reauth_start_domain=<domain>.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 12:08:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
19e2b3b6ba ERP: Add defines for EAP Re-Authentication Protocol
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-04 00:58:14 +02:00
Jithu Jance
0d4e3d1d13 nl80211: Ignore Connect failure for the previous association
Suppose there are two APs (AP1 & AP2) and user attempted to connect to
AP2 before the previous connection with AP1 could succeed. Now, if the
connection event comes for the older AP with failed status, we should
just ignore it as the wpa_supplicant state has moved to "ASSOCIATING"
with the new AP (AP2).

This is a similar to the case where a disconnection event is ignored for
a case where local disconnect request can cause the extra event to show
up during the next association process following that command.

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2014-12-04 00:34:08 +02:00
Peng Xu
16689c7cfc hostapd: Allow ACS to be offloaded to the driver
Using QCA vendor command, allow ACS function to be offloaded to the
driver. Once channels are selected, hostapd is notified to perform OBSS
operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-03 22:31:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
994d6f4629 Add a name for an assigned QCA nl80211 vendor subcmd
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-02 23:36:12 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e48635cfb0 Rename QCA nl80211 vendor subcmds to match AOSP names
This makes the enum vendor_subcmds definitions more consistent with the
names used in Android.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-02 16:20:35 +02:00
Vivek Natarajan
b685e2aab7 atheros: Cleanup atheros_raw_receive to process all management frames
Signed-off-by: Vivek Natarajan <nataraja@qti.qualcomm.com>
2014-12-02 16:20:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
92e3c0b14c EAP-PAX: Derive EAP Session-Id
This adds EAP-PAX server and peer method functions for deriving
Session-Id from Method-Id per RFC 4746 and RFC 5247.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-01 01:46:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a7bec9e7b2 EAP-TTLS: Add support for deriving EMSK
This extends EAP-TTLS server and peer implementations to support EMSK
derivation per RFC 5281.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-01 01:28:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9429bee4cc EAP-TLS server: Clear temporary buffer during EMSK derivation
Now that EMSK derivation is taken into use with ERP, it is better to
make sure the temporary MSK + EMSK buffer does not get left in heap
after use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-12-01 01:28:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d1f89dd732 EAP server: Add getSessionId
This extends EAP server implementation to derive Session-Id similarly to
the existing EAP peer implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d68f74c5ff EAP peer: Clean up TLS Session-Id derivation function
The comment about library not supporting Session-Id derivation was not
accurate and there is no need to check for master key that is not used
as part of derivation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0a11409c00 Fix omac1_aes_128_vector() not to read beyond addr/len array
Previously, it was possible for the loop through the data components to
increment addr/len index at the last position beyond the declared size.
This resulted in reading beyond those arrays. The read values were not
used and as such, this was unlikely to cause noticeable issues, but
anyway, memory checkers can detect this and the correct behavior is to
stop increments before going beyond the arrays since no more bytes will
be processed after this anyway.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-30 15:53:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
631739b361 Clear WLAN_STA_ASSOC_REQ_OK on AP-initiated deauthentication
This flag was left in the STA entry for the short duration after the STA
gets deauthenticated. If the STA sends a Class 2 or 3 frame during that
short time, the AP would not have replied with Deauthentication frame
indicating no association is present.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-29 13:31:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0ecff8d7c3 Add hostapd driver_params config parameter
This is mainly for development testing purposes to allow driver_nl80211
behavior to be modified.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-29 13:24:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ebd557288c Remove forgotten driver_test.c variables
hostapd was still providing couple of parameters that were used only in
the already removed driver_test.c framework.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-29 12:49:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bd26031b4b wext: Fix non-WPA/WPA2 connection with extra IEs
The associate() handler was not prepared for params->wpa_ie containing
some other IEs than WPA/RSN IE and ended up configuring security policy
incorrectly for open networks if such IEs were present. Fix this by
using wpa_proto parameter instead of IEs to determine security policy
for driver configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 23:02:30 +02:00
Johannes Berg
d306df7919 wext: Add very basic status command support
Just to make the test framework happy, it uses the driver
status command to obtain the interface MAC address.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-11-28 23:02:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3c02cfdb3a proxyarp: Do not limit NDISC snoop packet size to 150
The RA, NS, and NA packets may be longer, so do not arbitrarily limit
the packet socket capture size to 150 bytes in the socket filter.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 22:41:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
bcb132e185 proxyarp: Validate IPv4 header total length value in dhcp_snoop
This field needs to be validated in addition to validating the total
length of the received frame to avoid reading beyond the frame buffer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 22:41:26 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8c5043b42c proxyarp: Relax frame length limit for RA and NA
Only the NS frames should be checked to be long enough to cover all the
fields used in the NS data structure. This allows shorter RA and NA
frames to be processed for multicast-to-unicast rules.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 22:37:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ef3ea80c68 proxyarp: Fix x_snoop multicast-to-unicast debug print
l2_packet_send() returns >= 0 on success, i.e., non-zero value does not
mean failure. Fix this debug print to show up only on negative return
values.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 22:37:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
89052e9952 proxyarp: Add debug log entry on multicast-to-unicast conversion
This makes it easier to debug operations. The debug message is marked
EXCESSIVE, though, to avoid filling the logs with too much information
in default debugging cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 22:37:05 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
df131d4597 proxyarp: Try multicast-to-unicast conversion only for authorized STAs
There is no point in trying to send the unicast converted version to a
STA that is not in authorized state since the driver would be expected
to drop normal TX Data frames in such state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-28 22:36:56 +02:00
Rashmi Ramanna
ac330cfd87 P2P: Reinvite with social operation channel if no common channels
If invitation to reinvoke a persistent group from the GO fails with the
peer indicating that there are no common channels, there is no defined
means for the peer to indicate which channel could have worked. Since
this type of issue with available channels changing over time can
happen, try to work around this by retrying invitation using one of the
social channels as the operating channel unless a specific operating
channel was forced for the group.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 17:55:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f33c82d23e nl80211: Change iftype to station on leaving mesh
This is needed to make following operations behave as expected since
mesh iftypes may prevent various operations (e.g., registering Probe
Request frame RX). Use same design as leave_ibss does to handle this
consistently.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 17:12:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
7a94120ea9 nl80211: Clear ignore_if_down_event if interface is up
It was possible for the ignore_if_down_event flag to remain set in some
cases where interface mode change required the interface to be set down
temporarily. If that happened, the following rfkill interface down could
have been ignored and device could have been left trying to scan or
connect (which would all fail due to the interface beign down). Clean
this up by clearing the ignore_if_down_event flag on the interface down
event regardless of whether the interface is up at the time this event
is processed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-27 14:59:28 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8997613c90 nl80211: Fix br_ifindex storing when hostapd creates the bridge
Commit 6c6678e7a4 ('nl80211: Make
br_ifindex available in i802_bss') did not cover the case where
i802_check_bridge() ends up creating the bridge interface. That left
bss->br_ifindex zero and prevented neighbor addition. Extend that
functionality to update br_ifindex once the bridge netdev has been
added.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-26 01:16:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a6b4ee217a proxyarp: Print learned IPv6 address in debug log
This makes it easier to debug issues related to IPv6 address snooping.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-26 01:09:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a7fb5ea463 proxyarp: Fix DHCP and ND message structures
These need to be marked packed to avoid issues with compilers
potentially adding padding between the fields (e.g., gcc on 64-bit
seemed to make struct icmpv6_ndmsg two octets too long which broke IPv6
address discovery).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-26 01:09:54 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a437378f98 proxyarp: Use C library header files and CONFIG_IPV6
This replaces the use of Linux kernel header files (linux/ip.h,
linux/udp.h, linux/ipv6.h, and linux/icmpv6.h) with equivalent header
files from C library. In addition, ndisc_snoop.c is now built
conditionally on CONFIG_IPV6=y so that it is easier to handle hostapd
builds with toolchains that do not support IPv6 even if Hotspot 2.0 is
enabled in the build.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-25 16:58:21 +02:00
Masashi Honma
a959a3b69d SAE: Fix Anti-Clogging Token request frame format
This commit inserts Finite Cyclic Group to Anti-Clogging Token request
frame because IEEE Std 802.11-2012, Table 8-29 says "Finite Cyclic Group
is present if Status is zero or 76".

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-11-25 16:08:53 +02:00
Masashi Honma
872b754512 mesh: Fix SAE anti-clogging functionality for mesh
The mesh anti-clogging functionality is implemented partially. This
patch fixes to parse anti-clogging request frame and use anti-clogging
token.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-11-25 15:33:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
649c0a6974 WPA: Use more explicit WPA/RSN selector count validation
Some static analyzers had problems understanding "left < count * len"
(CID 62855, CID 62856), so convert this to equivalent "count > left /
len" (len here is fixed to 4, so this can be done efficiently).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:08:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
adf96fb66b WPS: Add explicit message length limit of 50000 bytes
Previously, this was implicitly limited by the 16-bit length field to
65535. This resulted in unhelpful static analyzer warnings (CID 62868).
Add an explicit (but pretty arbitrary) limit of 50000 bytes to avoid
this. The actual WSC messages are significantly shorter in practice, but
there is no specific protocol limit, so 50000 is as good as any limit to
use here.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5c6787a6ca PeerKey: Clean up EAPOL-Key Key Data processing on AP
This extends the earlier PeerKey station side design to be used on the
AP side as well by passing pointer and already validated length from the
caller rather than parsing the length again from the frame buffer. This
avoids false warnings from static analyzer (CID 62870, CID 62871,
CID 62872).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d36f416926 EAP-IKEv2: Make proposal_len validation clearer
Some static analyzers seem to have issues understanding "pos +
proposal_len > end" style validation, so convert this to "proposal_len >
end - pos" to make this more obvious to be bounds checking for
proposal_len. (CID 62874)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c4de71cec5 EAP-FAST: Make PAC file A_ID parser easier to analyze
Some static analyzers seem to have issues with "pos + len > end"
validation (CID 62875), so convert this to "len > end - pos" to make it
more obvious that len is validated against its bounds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
364182a80f EAP-FAST: Clean up binary PAC file parser validation steps
This was too difficult for some static analyzers (CID 62876). In
addition, the pac_info_len assignment should really have explicitly
validated that there is room for the two octet length field instead of
trusting the following validation step to handle both this and the
actual pac_info_len bounds checking.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
002a2495be radiotap: Initialize all members in ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init()
_next_ns_data could look like it would be used uninitialized in
ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() to static analyzers. Avoid
unnecessary reports by explicitly initializing all variables in struct
ieee80211_radiotap_iterator. (CID 62878)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
3e94937fa4 P2P: Make p2p_parse_p2p_ie() validation steps easier to analyze
Validation was fine, but a bit too complex for some static analyzers to
understand. (CID 68125)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:40 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
46a0352589 Use more explicit num_pmkid validation in RSN IE parsing
Static analyzers may not have understood the bounds checking on
data->num_pmkid. Use a local, temporary variable and validate that that
value is within length limits before assining this to data->num_pmkid to
make this clearer. (CID 62857, CID 68126)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 21:03:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e7306bcb59 PCSC: Use clearer file TLV length validation step
This makes it easier for static analyzer to confirm that the length
field bounds are checked. WPA_GET_BE16() is also used instead of
explicit byte-swapping operations in this file. (CID 68129)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 18:37:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
76874379d3 TLS client: Check DH parameters using a local variable
Use a temporary, local variable to check the DH parameters received from
the server before assigning the length to the struct tlsv1_client
variables. This will hopefully make it easier for static analyzers to
figure out that there is bounds checking for the value. (CID 72699)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 17:48:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b81e274cdf RADIUS client: Print a clear debug log entry if socket is not available
It could have been possible to select a socket that is not open
(sel_sock == -1) and try to use that in socket operations. This would
fail with potentially confusing error messages. Make this clearer by
printing a clear debug log entry on socket not being available.
(CID 72696)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 17:41:13 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f931374f30 IKEv2: Use a bit clearer payload header validation step
It looks like the "pos + plen > end" case was not clear enough for a
static analyzer to figure out that plen was being verified to not go
beyond the buffer. (CID 72687)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-23 16:37:16 +02:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
70d1e72849 wpa_supplicant: Handle link measurement requests
Send link measurement response when a request is received. Advertise
only RCPI, computing it from the RSSI of the request. The TX power field
is left to be filled by the driver. All other fields are not published.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:45:07 +02:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
7dc0338806 nl80211: Register Link Measurement Request Action frame
Add link measurement request to registration of Action frames to be
handled by wpa_supplicant if the driver supports TX power value
insertation.

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:38:30 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
f4b8bfae15 wpa_supplicant: Add NEIGHBOR_REP_REQUEST command to the control interface
Add NEIGHBOR_REP_REQUEST command to the wpa_supplicant ctrl_iface.
This command triggers the sending of a Neighbor Report Request to the
associated AP.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:28:52 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
d89c0701db wpa_supplicant: Add support for Neighbor Report
Add the ability to send a Neighbor Report Request (part of
RRM). Requester is then notified once the report arrives.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:23:14 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
2526ccd95a nl80211: Register Neighbor Report Response Action frame
Add Neighbor Report Response Action frame to registration of Action
frames to be handled by wpa_supplicant.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:16:25 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
b361d580ec SME: Add RRM support to association request
In case the AP we are associating with advertises support for RRM,
advertise our own RRM support in the (Re)Association Request frame. This
is done by adding an RRM Capabilities IE. The underlying driver is
expected to further add a Power Capabilities IE to the request, and set
the Radio Measurement flag in the Capability Info field. At this point
the RRM Capabilities IE advertises no measurement support.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:13:45 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
58162adf06 nl80211: Populate RRM flags in nl80211 driver
Set the RRM capability flags, based on the capabilities reported
by the underlying driver.

In addition, upon connection, notify the underlying driver regarding
RRM support.

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:06:32 +02:00
Assaf Krauss
0dc957b93d driver: Add RRM-related definitions to driver interface
Add definitions for RRM (Radio Resource Measurement) support:
1. Flags that specify the RRM capabilities of the underlying driver
2. Flag for RRM in Capability Info field in Management frames
3. Indication in association parameters regarding an RRM connection

Signed-off-by: Assaf Krauss <assaf.krauss@intel.com>
2014-11-22 21:05:55 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
533630625d Add generic operating class and channel to frequency function
ieee80211_chan_to_freq() is a generic function that replaces and extends
the previous P2P-specific p2p_channel_to_freq(). The new function
supports both the global operating class table as well as the additional
US, EU, JP, and CN operating class tables.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 20:17:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
5351480047 Add BSS-TM-RESP ctrl_iface event
This event allows external monitors to track STA response to BSS
Transition Management Request.

BSS-TM-RESP <STA addr> status_code=<#> bss_termination_delay=<#>
[target_bssid=<BSSID>]

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-22 16:34:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a30dff07fb Add BSS_TM_REQ command to send BSS Transition Management Request
hostapd control interface can now be used to request transmission of a
BSS Transition Management Request frame to a specified station.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-22 16:34:34 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
37df6a87dd Add names for assigned QCA nl80211 vendor subcmds
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-21 21:46:01 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f23c5b17e1 AP: Extend EAPOL-Key msg 1/4 retry workaround for changing SNonce
If the 4-way handshake ends up having to retransmit the EAPOL-Key
message 1/4 due to a timeout on waiting for the response, it is possible
for the Supplicant to change SNonce between the first and second
EAPOL-Key message 2/4. This is not really desirable due to extra
complexities it causes on the Authenticator side, but some deployed
stations are doing this.

This message sequence looks like this:
AP->STA: EAPOL-Key 1/4 (replay counter 1, ANonce)
AP->STA: EAPOL-Key 1/4 (replay counter 2, ANonce)
STA->AP: EAPOL-Key 2/4 (replay counter 1, SNonce 1)
AP->STA: EAPOL-Key 3/4 (replay counter 3, ANonce)
STA->AP: EAPOL-Key 2/4 (replay counter 2, SNonce 2)
followed by either:
STA->AP: EAPOL-Key 4/4 (replay counter 3 using PTK from SNonce 1)
or:
AP->STA: EAPOL-Key 3/4 (replay counter 4, ANonce)
STA->AP: EAPOL-Key 4/4 (replay counter 4, using PTK from SNonce 2)

Previously, Authenticator implementation was able to handle the cases
where SNonce 1 and SNonce 2 were identifical (i.e., Supplicant did not
update SNonce which is the wpa_supplicant behavior) and where PTK
derived using SNonce 2 was used in EAPOL-Key 4/4. However, the case of
using PTK from SNonce 1 was rejected ("WPA: received EAPOL-Key 4/4
Pairwise with unexpected replay counter" since EAPOL-Key 3/4 TX and
following second EAPOL-Key 2/4 invalidated the Replay Counter that was
used previously with the first SNonce).

This commit extends the AP/Authenticator workaround to keep both SNonce
values in memory if two EAPOL-Key 2/4 messages are received with
different SNonce values. The following EAPOL-Key 4/4 message is then
accepted whether the MIC has been calculated with the latest SNonce (the
previously existing behavior) or with the earlier SNonce (the new
extension). This makes 4-way handshake more robust with stations that
update SNonce for each transmitted EAPOL-Key 2/4 message in cases where
EAPOL-Key message 1/4 needs to be retransmitted.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-21 17:02:00 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
db099951cb Print EAPOL-Key Replay Counter in Authenticator debug log
This makes it easier to debug issues relared to EAPOL-Key
retransmissions.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-21 15:35:19 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
066371ad52 Reserve QCA vendor specific nl80211 commands 53
These is reserved for QCA use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-20 20:36:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e503861f4d nl80211: Do not try to change STA capability on NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION
cfg80211 will reject any of these attributes regardless of whether the
values actually change or not when NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is used for
something else than TDLS. This path is hit at least when setting up
mesh, so filter out the attributes from NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION to match
the rules in cfg80211.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-20 16:31:05 +02:00
Rashmi Ramanna
9d11832090 P2P: Do not change P2P state on GO Neg failure if it is P2P_SEARCH
Changing the P2P state to P2P_IDLE on GO Negotiation Failure would stop
the previously issued P2P_FIND operation without notifying the upper
layers. Leave the search operation running if in P2P_SEARCH state to
avoid unexpected behavior in case the upper layers issued a new P2P_FIND
while waiting for GO Negotiation to complete.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:59:03 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
47261405d7 AP: Add support for multicast-to-unicast conversion for DGAF Disable
When DGAF Disable is on, perform multicast-to-unicast for DHCP packets
and Router Advertisement packets. This is a requirement for Hotspot 2.0.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:47:06 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
bd00c4311c AP: Add Neighbor Discovery snooping mechanism for Proxy ARP
This commit establishes the infrastructure, and handles the Neighbor
Solicitation and Neighbor Advertisement frames. This will be extended
in the future to handle other frames.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:47:06 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
5c58944d08 AP: Add multicast-to-unicast conversion send for "x_snoop"
Multicast-to-unicast conversion send will be needed in various part of
Proxy ARP and DGAF Disable.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:25:13 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
ed4ddb6d77 AP: Extend the BSS bridge neighbor entry management to support IPv6
This allows adding/deleting an IPv6 neighbor entry to/from the bridge,
to which the BSS belongs. This commit adds the needed functionality in
driver_nl80211.c for the Linux bridge implementation. In theory, this
could be shared with multiple Linux driver interfaces, but for now, only
the main nl80211 interface is supported.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:23:38 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
7e4d893978 l2_packet: Add support for NDISC packet filter in l2_packet_linux
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:15:26 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
1d783762cf AP: Convert "dhcp_snoop" to use the generic "x_snoop"
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:14:15 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
c127355cb8 AP: Add a generic "x_snoop" infrastructure for Proxy ARP
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-19 16:14:02 +02:00
Ilan Peer
38cb0a2db6 AP: Drop retransmitted auth/assoc/action frames
It is possible that a station device might miss an ACK for an
authentication, association, or action frame, and thus retransmit the
same frame although the frame is already being processed in the stack.
While the duplicated frame should really be dropped in the kernel or
firmware code where duplicate detection is implemented for data frames,
it is possible that pre-association cases are not fully addressed (which
is the case at least with mac80211 today) and the frame may be delivered
to upper layer stack.

In such a case, the local AP will process the retransmitted frame although
it has already handled the request, which might cause the station to get
confused and as a result disconnect from the AP, blacklist it, etc.

To avoid such a case, save the sequence control of the last processed
management frame and in case of retransmissions drop them.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-11-19 15:20:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
453553698c EAP-pwd: Remove unnecessary OpenSSL EVP_sha256() registration
This gets registered in tls_openssl.c from tls_init(), so there is no
need for EAP-pwd implementation to register explicitly. This avoids some
corner cases where OpenSSL resources do not get fully freed on exit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-17 01:20:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
afbe57d981 DFS: Fix hostapd operation without hw_mode driver data
If DFS implementation was built in, some configurations with drivers
that do not provide mode information could end up dereferencing a NULL
pointer. Fix this by skipping DFS operations in such cases since not
having information about modes and channels means that hostapd could not
perform DFS anyway (i.e., either this is not a wireless driver or the
driver takes care of DFS internally).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-17 01:14:35 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
e9b783d58c Fix hostapd operation without hw_mode driver data
Commit 7f0303d5b0 ('hostapd: Verify VHT
160/80+80 MHz driver support') added couple of hapd->iface->current_mode
dereferences of which the one in hostapd_set_freq() can be hit with some
configuration files when using driver wrappers that do not have hw_mode
data, i.e., when current_mode is NULL. This could result in segmentation
fault when trying to use driver=wired. Fix this by checking that
current_mode is not NULL before dereferencing it to get vht_capab.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-17 01:08:04 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
01b24c52df wired: Fix deinit path to unregister eloop read_sock
The previous version was leaving behind registered eloop socket
instances.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-17 00:57:15 +02:00
Moshe Benji
71d263ea70 Add wpa_scnprintf() helper function
This provides a simpler version of snprintf that doesn't require further
error checks.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:40:42 +02:00
Moshe Benji
dfa8787833 nl80211: Implement add_ts/del_ts ops
Add ops to notify about TSPECs to add/remove. Additionally, subscribe to
ADDTS/DELTS Action frames to be able to process WMM AC Action frames.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:21:22 +02:00
Eliad Peller
1b640fd27c Add str_token() function
Add helper function to get the next token from a string.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2014-11-16 21:11:23 +02:00
Moshe Benji
d1f880013a WMM AC: Handle TSPEC action frames
Add the TSPEC to the driver on successful TSPEC ADDTS response. Delete
the TSPEC when receiving DELTS action.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 21:07:08 +02:00
Moshe Benji
471cd6e10c WMM AC: Add add_tx_ts and del_tx_ts driver ops
Add add_tx_ts() and del_tx_ts() ops to notify the driver about
TSPEC add / delete.

Additionally, add wmm_ac_supported flag to indicate
whether the driver supports WMM AC.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-11-16 20:47:36 +02:00
Moshe Benji
a0413b1734 WMM AC: Parse WMM IE on association
Initialize WMM AC data structures upon successful association
with an AP that publishes WMM support, and deinitialize the data
structure when the association is no longer valid.

Signed-off-by: Moshe Benji <moshe.benji@intel.com>
Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2014-11-16 20:47:34 +02:00
Eliad Peller
7e0e10693a nl80211: Parse WMM parameters on association
Set the relevant WMM parameters in the assoc_data event.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2014-11-16 20:19:04 +02:00
Eliad Peller
0f14a44e6b drivers: Add WMM parameters to association event data
The WMM parameters will be used later for setting default tspec values.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2014-11-16 20:16:58 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
d308d1a899 Sync with wireless-testing.git include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h
This brings in nl80211 definitions as of 2014-11-11.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-16 20:08:00 +02:00
Masashi Honma
e609679984 mesh: Make plink params configurable
This patch makes four MIB variables for plink configurable and sets the
correct default values based on IEEE Std 802.11s-2011.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Masashi Honma
790709060d mesh: Add scan result for mesh network
Android 4.4 uses "BSS" command instead of "SCAN_RESULT" command.
So this patch add the mesh scan result for BSS command.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Javier Lopez
603a3f34c4 Add mesh_group_{add,remove} control interface commands
Parse MESH_GROUP_ADD/REMOVE commands on ctrl interface and call
wpa_supplicant routines. These commands are used to start or
join and leave a mesh network.

The mesh id is given in the configuration file, therefore there is
no need to scan before joining a mesh network. We reuse the
connect_without_scan construct used by P2P for that same purpose.

Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Jason Mobarak
5cfb672dde mesh: Enable mesh HT mode
Add a new option "mesh_ht_mode" that specifies the HT mode for the
mesh, with this option on, mesh beacons, actions frames, and probe
responses with include the appropriate HT information elements.

[original implementation by Chun-Yeow Yeoh <yeohchunyeow@gmail.com>]
[some fixes by Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>]
Signed-off-by: Ashok Nagarajan <ashok.dragon@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Chun-Yeow Yeoh
c596f3f083 mesh: Add timer for SAE authentication in RSN mesh
Add timer to do SAE re-authentication with number of tries defined
by MESH_AUTH_RETRY and timeout defined by MESH_AUTH_TIMEOUT.

Ignoring the sending of reply message on "SAE confirm before commit"
to avoid "ping-pong" issues with other mesh nodes. This is obvious when
number of mesh nodes in MBSS reaching 6.

Signed-off-by: Chun-Yeow Yeoh <yeohchunyeow@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Bob Copeland
c50d94f1f8 mesh: Start mesh peering after successful authentication
[original patch by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>]
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Bob Copeland
e96da42b0e SAE: Enhance AP implementation to handle auth for mesh interfaces
Add state transition logic to the SAE frame handling in order to more
fully implement the state machine from the IEEE 802.11 standard. Special
cases are needed for infrastructure BSS case to avoid unexpected
Authentication frame sequence by postponing transmission of the second
Authentication frame untile the STA sends its Confirm.

[original patch by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>]
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-11-16 19:43:11 +02:00
Thomas Pedersen
0f950df029 mesh: Add mesh robust security network
This implementation provides:

- Mesh SAE authentication mechanism
- Key management (set/get PSK)
- Cryptographic key establishment
- Enhanced protection mechanisms for robust management frames

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>
2014-11-16 19:43:06 +02:00
Dmitry Shmidt
88cb27c7a5 hostapd: Add wowlan_triggers config param
New kernels in wiphy_suspend() will call cfg80211_leave_all() that will
eventually end up in cfg80211_stop_ap() unless wowlan_triggers were set.
For now, use the parameters from the station mode as-is. It may be
desirable to extend (or constraint) this in the future for specific AP
mode needs.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2014-11-16 17:09:11 +02:00
Ilan Peer
f03996565a nl80211: Fix Android compilation by adding include for fcntl.h
This is needed for fcntl() at least with Android KK.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-11-16 17:09:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
929a2ea5df Suite B: Select EAPOL-Key integrity and key-wrap algorithms based on AKM
This adds support for AKM 00-0F-AC:11 to specify the integrity and
key-wrap algorithms for EAPOL-Key frames using the new design where
descriptor version is set to 0 and algorithms are determined based on
AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-16 17:09:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
087a1f4efd Suite B: PMKID derivation for AKM 00-0F-AC:11
The new AKM uses a different mechanism of deriving the PMKID based on
KCK instead of PMK. hostapd was already doing this after the KCK had
been derived, but wpa_supplicant functionality needs to be moved from
processing of EAPOL-Key frame 1/4 to 3/4 to have the KCK available.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-16 17:09:11 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
666497c8e6 Suite B: Add AKM 00-0F-AC:11
This adds definitions for the 128-bit level Suite B AKM 00-0F-AC:11. The
functionality itself is not yet complete, i.e., this commit only
includes parts to negotiate the new AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-16 13:20:51 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
35efa2479f OpenSSL: Allow TLS v1.1 and v1.2 to be negotiated by default
Use SSLv23_method() to enable TLS version negotiation for any version
equal to or newer than 1.0. If the old behavior is needed as a
workaround for some broken authentication servers, it can be configured
with phase1="tls_disable_tlsv1_1=1 tls_disable_tlsv1_2=1".

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-15 12:35:10 +02:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
281ff42a01 EAP-IKEv2: Fix compilation warning
Fix signed/unsigned comparison compilation warning introduced in
08ef442 "EAP-IKEv2: Fix the payload parser".

Signed-off-by: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2014-11-15 11:41:09 +02:00
Dmitry Shmidt
d10792199e Add CTRL-EVENT-SCAN-FAILED notification in case of scan failure
This is needed since the SCAN command with radio work returns before the
actual driver operation to trigger a scan has been executed and as such,
cannot return result of that operation.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2014-11-15 11:03:52 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9f6a7cddc4 Work around AP misbehavior on EAPOL-Key descriptor version
It looks like some APs are incorrectly selecting descriptor version 3
(AES-128-CMAC) for EAPOL-Key frames when version 2 (HMAC-SHA1) was
expected to be used. This is likely triggered by an attempt to negotiate
PMF with SHA1-based AKM.

Since AES-128-CMAC is considered stronger than HMAC-SHA1, allow the
incorrect, but stronger, option to be used in these cases to avoid
interoperability issues with deployed APs.

This issue shows up with "WPA: CCMP is used, but EAPOL-Key descriptor
version (3) is not 2" in debug log. With the new workaround, this issue
is ignored and "WPA: Interoperability workaround: allow incorrect
(should have been HMAC-SHA1), but stronger (is AES-128-CMAC), descriptor
version to be used" is written to the log.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-14 21:01:13 +02:00
Yanbo Li
e3a8ad4405 hostapd: Change drv_flags from unsigned int to u64
Some flag already using a bit larger than 32, so extend the hostapd
drv_flags type similarly to the earlier wpa_supplicant change to get the
full flag content.

Signed-off-by: Yanbo Li <yanbol@qti.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-14 12:55:53 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
41a233572e Assign QCA vendor specific nl80211 command id 52 for APFIND
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-11-13 16:27:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
68ee1cdca0 Remove unused EVENT_MLME_RX
This was used in driver_test.c, but that driver wrapper has been removed
and there are no remaining or expected users for EVENT_MLME_RX.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-01 19:31:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0f812c993b Remove unused EVENT_FT_RRB_RX
This was used in hostapd driver_test.c, but that driver wrapper has been
removed and there are no remaining or expected users for
EVENT_FT_RRB_RX.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-01 19:27:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f21495ad38 madwifi: Remove obsolete madwifi driver interface
The MadWifi project is not active anymore and the last release happened
in early 2008. As such, there is no remaining justification for
maintaining the madwifi-specific driver interface for hostapd either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-11-01 16:15:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
b5ea99377f P2P: Document p2p_in_progress() return value 2
Function documentation was not in sync with the implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-31 00:50:01 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
b951a97454 P2P: Set p2p_scan_running based on driver scan request result
With the radio work interface, the actual request to start p2p_scan
operation is scheduled from a radio work and hence the initial return
value cannot provide the real result of the driver operation to trigger
a scan. Introduce a new notification API to indicate the scan trigger
status based on which the p2p_scan_running instance can be set using the
real return value from the driver operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-31 00:05:25 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
43d8592718 MACsec: Fix policy configuration
macsec_validate variable was set incorrectly to FALSE(0) or TRUE(1)
instead of the enum validate_frames values (Disabled(0), Checked(1),
Strict(2). This ended up policy == SHOULD_SECURE to be mapped to
macsec_validate == Checked instead of Strict. This could have resulted
in unintended SecY forwarding of invalid packets rather than dropping
them.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-30 11:43:47 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8c00fd00cd P2P: Clean up p2p_go_neg_failed() calls
This function is always called with the peer argument equal to
p2p->go_neg_peer, so there is no need for that argument to be there. In
addition, p2p->go_neg_peer is not NULL in cases where there is an
ongoing GO Negotiation, so the function can be simplified to just check
once whether the peer pointer is set and if not, skip all processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-29 13:04:09 +02:00
Rashmi Ramanna
0c6eee8b75 P2P: Use timer to fail GO Negotation while waiting for peer
The timeout check while waiting for the peer to accept the GO
Negotiation depended on the WAIT_PEER_IDLE or WAIT_PEER_CONNECT states
being in use. Any P2P command to alter such states would have resulted
in the failure to time out GO Negotiation and thus ended up in not
indicating GO Negotiation failure or left the selected peer available
for new GO negotiation after the expected two minute timeout.

Fix this by using a separate timer to time out GO Negotiation
irrespective of the P2P state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-29 12:50:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
10bbe8b8ed nl80211: Fix a copy-paste error in key offload management
Commit b41f26845a ('Add support for
offloading key management operations to the driver') used incorrect
variable for determining the KCK length. This does not get triggered in
normal use cases since KCK and KEK are always included and of the same
length (in currently supported key management cases). Anyway, this needs
to be fixed to check the correct attribute. (CID 74491)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-28 01:41:57 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
7d597d4617 AP: Add support for Proxy ARP, DHCP snooping mechanism
Proxy ARP allows the AP devices to keep track of the hardware address to
IP address mapping of the STA devices within the BSS. When a request for
such information is made (i.e., ARP request, Neighbor Solicitation), the
AP will respond on behalf of the STA device within the BSS. Such
requests could originate from a device within the BSS or also from the
bridge. In the process of the AP replying to the request (i.e., ARP
reply, Neighbor Advertisement), the AP will drop the original request
frame. The relevant STA will not even know that such information was
ever requested.

This feature is a requirement for Hotspot 2.0, and is defined in IEEE
Std 802.11-2012, 10.23.13. While the Proxy ARP support code mainly
resides in the kernel bridge code, in order to optimize the performance
and simplify kernel implementation, the DHCP snooping code was added to
the hostapd.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
6897556455 common: Add definition for ETH_HLEN
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
7565752d47 AP: Add support for setting bridge network parameter
This allows setting a network parameter on the bridge that the BSS
belongs to.

This commit adds the needed functionality in driver_nl80211.c for the
Linux bridge implementation. In theory, this could be shared with
multiple Linux driver interfaces, but for now, only the main nl80211
interface is supported.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
73d2294fbe AP: Add support for setting bridge port attributes
This allows setting a bridge port attribute. Specifically, the bridge
port in this context is the port to which the BSS belongs.

This commit adds the needed functionality in driver_nl80211.c for the
Linux bridge implementation. In theory, this could be shared with
multiple Linux driver interfaces, but for now, only the main nl80211
interface is supported.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
71103bed42 AP: Add support for IPv4 neighbor entry management to the BSS bridge
This allows adding/deleting an IPv4 neighbor entry to/from the bridge,
to which the BSS belongs. This commit adds the needed functionality in
driver_nl80211.c for the Linux bridge implementation. In theory, this
could be shared with multiple Linux driver interfaces, but for now, only
the main nl80211 interface is supported.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
6c6678e7a4 nl80211: Make br_ifindex available in i802_bss
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Kyeyoon Park
7d20dd66f3 l2_packet: Add support for DHCP packet filter in l2_packet_linux
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-28 01:08:29 +02:00
Ahmad Masri
d77419d234 P2P: Support GCMP as part of 60 GHz support
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-27 17:15:09 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
159a17916f nl80211: Move more event processing into driver_nl80211_event.c
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
8a906d1251 nl80211: Move event handling into a separate file
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
0fafeb5454 nl80211: Move capability determination into a separate file
This moves significant amount of code away from large driver_nl80211.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
906bc4c7d3 nl80211: Move QCA DFS offload capability determination to init time
There is no need to fetch this capability for each get_capa() call.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
981cf85a41 nl80211: Move AP monitor interface handling to a separate file
This moves the old monitor interface design to driver_nl80211_monitor.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f3407c66c2 nl80211: Make some helper functions non-static
This allows more functionality to be moved to separate files.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
70a96c8116 nl80211: Move most of the Android code into a separate file
This moves most of the Android specific implementation from
driver_nl80211.c to driver_nl80211_android.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:54:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1474e6e917 nl80211: Move definitions into separate header files
This is an initial step in starting to split the large driver_nl80211.c
implementation into somewhat smaller parts.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 17:03:24 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
2f06bcb361 Write human readable version of channel width to CSA event debug log
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 11:36:14 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
392dfd37e8 nl80211: Store externally managed bridge name in driver status
This makes it easier to figure out from hostapd control interface
whether an interface had been added to a bridge externally at the time
hostapd interface was enabled or if the interface gets added during
hostapd operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 11:27:31 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
ab93fdebf1 hostapd: Add INTERFACE-ENABLED and INTERFACE-DISABLED events
These can be convenient for upper layer programs to determine if the
hostapd interface gets disabled/re-enabled, e.g., due to rfkill
block/unblock.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-26 10:52:54 +02:00
Ilan Peer
1170239efa P2P: Save group common frequencies in invitation result
Save the group common frequencies when starting a GO due to
an invitation signaling requesting to re-invoke a persistent GO.

To do so, move the code that handles the translation of p2p_channels to
frequency list into a public function so it can be re-used both when GO
Negotiation is done and invitation signaling is done.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-10-26 01:24:28 +03:00
Ilan Peer
f64d3f0e15 WPS: Add missing device types
Add missing device category and device sub category definitions.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-10-26 01:24:08 +03:00
Ilan Peer
9bc5cfa338 nl80211: Clear beacon_set when deleting a beacon from deinit_ap()
When a beacon was deleted from the kernel in
wpa_driver_nl80211_deinit_ap(), bss->beacon_set was not cleared so
restarting the AP again was not possible.

Fix this by clearing the variable once the beacon was deleted.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-10-26 01:24:03 +03:00
Ilan Peer
ea6bf29ea3 nl80211: Add indoor only and GO concurrent flags
Add the following channel flags:

* INDOOR_ONLY: The channel can be used if and only if there is a clear
  assessment that the device is operating in an indoor environment, i.e.,
  it is AC power.

* CONCURRENT_GO: The channel can be used for instantiating a GO if and
  only if there is an additional station interface that is currently
  connected to an AP on the same channel or on the same U-NII band
  (assuming that the AP is an authorized master).

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-10-26 01:23:46 +03:00
Ilan Peer
0a44358055 wpa_supplicant: Use the 'no_ir' notation
Use the 'no_ir' notation instead of the 'passive scan' and
'no_ibss' notations to match the earlier change in nl80211.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-10-26 01:23:43 +03:00
Constantin Musca
a902d5a64b P2P: Stop driver listen in p2p_state_timeout()
When a P2P timeout occurs and p2p_state_timeout is executed, the
stop_listen function can be called besides setting in_listen to zero in
cases where the driver is still in ROC. That should not really happen in
normal cases, but it is possible for some drivers to extend the ROC
duration. If that happens, the next start_listen request may get
rejected with "P2P: Reject start_listen since p2p_listen_work already
exists".

Signed-off-by: Constantin Musca <constantin.musca@intel.com>
2014-10-25 21:37:18 +03:00
Javier Lopez
01e2231fdc hostapd: Skip some configuration steps for mesh cases
Modify hostapd.c logic to add checks for valid mconf data structure:

- For hostapd_setup_bss we don't need to flush old stations in case
  we're rejoining a mesh network.

- In hostapd_setup_interface_complete, we don't need to setup the
  interface until we join the mesh (same reasoning for
  hostapd_tx_queue_params).

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
2014-10-25 17:45:36 +03:00
Bob Copeland
f3e9899e02 mesh: Accept Action frames without BSSID match
[original patch by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>]
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 17:45:35 +03:00
Thomas Pedersen
476e6bb68d mesh: Add mesh mode config option
Modify network mode to support mode number 5 when CONFIG_MESH is
enabled.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>
2014-10-25 17:45:35 +03:00
Bob Copeland
5f92659d88 mesh: Add mesh peering manager
The mesh peering manager establishes and maintains links among
mesh peers, tracking each peer link via a finite state machine.

This implementation supports open mesh peerings.

[assorted fixes from Yu Niiro <yu.niiro@gmail.com>]
[more fixes from Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>]
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Ashok Nagarajan <ashok.dragon@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-hostap: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 17:45:31 +03:00
Thomas Pedersen
8319e3120d mesh: Add mesh mode routines
Add routines to (de)initialize mesh interface data structures and
join and leave mesh networks.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>
2014-10-25 17:43:20 +03:00
Bob Copeland
5551bc9cb2 nl80211: Do not try to change supported rates
For mesh mode to work properly, set supported rates only once.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 15:54:57 +03:00
Bob Copeland
7a228b5c3f nl80211: Add STA flag WPA_STA_AUTHENTICATED
This is needed for managing STA entries for mesh use cases.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 15:54:47 +03:00
Bob Copeland
7c7e7877fc nl80211: Add plink_action_field to hostapd_sta_add_params
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 15:54:38 +03:00
Bob Copeland
0d391b03e7 nl80211: Reject deauth/disassoc for mesh interface
sta_info call these to send out the disassoc and deauth frame
which are both not relevent to mesh. So don't send them.

Signed-off-by: Chun-Yeow Yeoh <yeohchunyeow@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 13:47:48 +03:00
Bob Copeland
afb0550a39 nl80211: Register to receive mesh frames
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-25 13:47:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
aed8d4d1ff nl80211: Write channel type in debug log on channel switch event
This makes it easier to understand what kind of channel switch was
indicated by the driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-25 11:28:56 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5de748187e Fix channel switch to disable VHT with HT
If both HT and VHT was enabled on AP and channel switch event from the
driver indicated that HT was disabled, VHT was left enabled. This
resulted in the following channel configuration failing. Fix this by
disabling VHT if HT gets disabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-25 11:27:48 +03:00
Eliad Peller
da1080d721 nl80211: Advertise and configure SMPS modes
Advertise static/dynamic SMPS mode support (according to the wiphy
feature bits) and pass the configured smps_mode when starting the AP.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-10-24 01:29:08 +03:00
Eliad Peller
8f461b50cf HT: Pass the smps_mode in AP parameters
The driver needs to know what SMPS mode it should use.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-10-24 01:27:31 +03:00
Eliad Peller
04ee647d58 HT: Let the driver advertise its supported SMPS modes for AP mode
Add smps_modes field, and let the driver fill it with its supported SMPS
modes (static/dynamic). This will let us start an AP with specific SMPS
mode (e.g., dynamic) that will allow it to reduce its power usage.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliad@wizery.com>
2014-10-24 01:25:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4db207518d P2P: Stop TX wait on SD query TX status failure
The previous TX operation could be on another channel if there are
multiple peers with pending SD queries. To avoid failing to send the
following query, stop the last one to allow any Listen channel to be
used for the following query during p2p_find iteration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-23 21:52:05 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
44abecbf02 P2P: Limit number of SD retries during find
Commit 7139cf4a4f ('P2P: Decrement
sd_pending_bcast_queries when sd returns success') added support for
retrying P2P SD queries. However, it did this without limiting how many
retries are allowed. This can result in excessive number of retries if a
peer device does not show up on its Listen channel and there is a
pending SD query to it. Limit the maximum number of SD retries to 100
per p2p_find operation for each peer to avoid unlimited retries.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-23 21:51:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e706b8c8e5 P2P: Iterate through all peers in pending pre-find operation
Commit 7139cf4a4f ('P2P: Decrement
sd_pending_bcast_queries when sd returns success') changed P2P SD
behavior in a way that the P2P search loop ended up in continuing with
the first peer entry until it acknowledged receipt of a pending
broadcast SD request while the previous design went through all peers
once. While it is reasonable to retry SD, getting stuck with the first
peer is not really desirable. Change the p2p_continue_find() loop to
continue from the next peer in each iteration to allow progress through
all peers that have pending operations if any other peer is not
acknowledging frames (e.g., due to not being on Listen channel).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-23 21:30:32 +03:00
Chet Lanctot
b41f26845a Add support for offloading key management operations to the driver
This commit introduces a QCA vendor command and event to provide an
option to use extended versions of the nl80211 connect/roam operations
in a way that allows drivers to offload key management operations to the
driver/firmware.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-23 18:38:50 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a6b1215769 GAS: Do not reply to P2P SD query from generic GAS/ANQP server
This avoids an issue where a wpa_supplicant build with CONFIG_P2P=y and
CONFIG_HS20=y ended up processing a P2P SD query twice when operating as
a GO and sending out two replies. Only the P2P SD implementation should
reply to P2P SD query in such a case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-22 19:21:42 +03:00
Johannes Berg
97752f7930 Revert "nl80211: Do not indicate P2P_DEVICE support by default"
This reverts commit 851b0c5581.

The kernel now has full support for this (and it is turned off
by default for hwsim) so wpa_supplicant should really go back
to autodetecting this so clients don't have to figure out what
to do.

Also add a debug message stating that P2P_DEVICE support is used.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-10-22 10:54:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ccf79ab256 browser-android: Use execv() directly instead of os_exec()
This allows the URL to be passed as a single argument to the program
instead of getting split into multiple by os_exec(). This makes the
operation more robust for cases where the URL could have been received
from an external source and could potentially add extra arguments to the
command line.

In addition, fix the /system/bin/input execution by using system() for
it instead of execv() through os_exec(). /system/bin/input is a script
that execv() won't be able to run. Since the full command line is
specified, system() can be used for this. The keycode is also changed
from 3 to KEYCODE_HOME to make this work with current Android version.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-21 23:32:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c94382259d browser-wpadebug: Use execv() directly instead of os_exec()
This allows the URL to be passed as a single argument to the program
instead of getting split into multiple by os_exec(). This makes the
operation more robust for cases where the URL could have been received
from an external source and could potentially add extra arguments to the
command line.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-21 23:32:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
22444bb246 browser-system: Use execv() directly instead of os_exec()
This allows the URL to be passed as a single argument to the program
instead of getting split into multiple by os_exec(). This makes the
operation more robust for cases where the URL could have been received
from an external source and could potentially add extra arguments to the
command line.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-21 23:32:17 +03:00
Kyeyoon Park
ec8f36afca AP: Add support for BSS load element (STA Count, Channel Utilization)
The new "bss_load_update_period" parameter can be used to configure
hostapd to advertise its BSS Load element in Beacon and Probe Response
frames. This parameter is in the units of BUs (Beacon Units).

When enabled, the STA Count and the Channel Utilization value will be
updated periodically in the BSS Load element. The AAC is set to 0 sinze
explicit admission control is not supported. Channel Utilization is
calculated based on the channel survey information from the driver and
as such, requires a driver that supports providing that information for
the current operating channel.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-21 23:25:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4a6cc86272 Add data test functionality
It is now possible to run hwsim_test like data connectivity test through
wpa_supplicant/hostapd control interface if CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y is
used for the build. Test functionality is enabled/disabled at runtime
with "DATA_TEST_CONFIG <1/0>". The "DATA_TEST_TX <dst> <src> <tos>"
command can be used to request a test frame to be transmitted.
"DATA-TEST-RX <dst> <src>" event is generated when the test frame is
received.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-19 20:51:45 +03:00
Andrei Otcheretianski
d66873f5cf Do not start CSA flow when CSA is not supported by the driver
Signed-hostap: Andrei Otcheretianski <andrei.otcheretianski@intel.com>
2014-10-19 15:39:59 +03:00
Bob Copeland
a52024c976 nl80211: Add new peer candidate event for mesh
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-19 12:58:13 +03:00
Bob Copeland
7e31703e4d nl80211: Add support for sta_add flags_mask
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-19 12:58:13 +03:00
Bob Copeland
6c1664f605 nl80211: Add new commands to support mesh interfaces
Create init_mesh, mesh_join, and mesh_leave actions to kernel.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-19 12:58:13 +03:00
Bob Copeland
24bd4e0be5 nl80211: Add driver flag to indicate mesh support
Convert the driver flags variable to u64 since there was no room for
more flags.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Javier Cardona <javier@cozybit.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-19 12:58:13 +03:00
Bob Copeland
f7072600be Implement RFC 5297 AES-SIV
Add an implementation of Synthetic Initialization Vector (SIV)
Authenticated Encryption Using the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES).

This mode of AES is used to protect peering frames when using
the authenticated mesh peering exchange.

Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-19 12:43:38 +03:00
Bob Copeland
6293f9ed07 mesh: Parse mesh-related information elements
Add support for parsing mesh id, mesh config, mesh peering,
AMPE and MIC information elements.

Signed-off-by: Bob Copeland <me@bobcopeland.com>
2014-10-19 11:20:05 +03:00
Thomas Pedersen
3e7b032f83 mesh: Add mesh protocol definitions
Signed-off-by: Javier Lopez <jlopex@gmail.com>
Signed-off-by: Jason Mobarak <x@jason.mobarak.name>
Signed-hostap: Thomas Pedersen <thomas@noack.us>
2014-10-19 11:20:05 +03:00
Mikael Kanstrup
a0a5f73e62 P2P: Include passive channels in invitation response
Patch 51e9f22809 added the option
p2p_add_cli_chan to allow P2P GC to connect on passive channels
assuming the GO should know whether allowed to send on these channels.
This patch adds missing cli_channels to invitation response messages
to allow re-connecting to a persistent group as GC on passive
channels.

Signed-off-by: Mikael Kanstrup <mikael.kanstrup@sonymobile.com>
2014-10-18 17:00:57 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bc26ac50dd SAE: Add support for PMKSA caching on the station side
This makes wpa_supplicant SME create PMKSA cache entries from SAE
authentication and try to use PMKSA caching if an entry is found for the
AP. If the AP rejects the attempt, fall back to SAE authentication is
used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-18 13:02:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f299117093 SAE: Add support for PMKSA caching on the AP side
This makes hostapd create PMKSA cache entries from SAE authentication
and allow PMKSA caching to be used with the SAE AKM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-18 13:00:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
fcc306e3cc Add Acct-Multi-Session-Id into RADIUS Accounting messages
This allows multiple sessions using the same PMKSA cache entry to be
combined more easily at the server side. Acct-Session-Id is still a
unique identifier for each association, while Acct-Multi-Session-Id will
maintain its value for all associations that use the same PMKSA.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-18 10:38:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
aff039fada Remove duplicated Acct-Session-Id from Accounting-Request
Commit 8b24861154 ('Add Acct-Session-Id
into Access-Request messages') added Acct-Session-Id building into the
helper function shared between authentication and accounting messages.
However, it forgot to remove the same code from the generation of
accounting messages and as such, ended up with Accounting-Request
messages containing two copies of this attribute. Fix this by removing
the addition of this attribute from the accounting specific function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-18 10:35:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0ffe7a5481 RADIUS: Define new attributes from RFC 5580
This adds definition and names for the RADIUS attributes defined in RFC
5580 (Carrying Location Objects in RADIUS and Diameter).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-18 09:30:35 +03:00
Justin Shen
3f7ac05878 WPS: Extend startWhen to 2 if peer AP supports WPS 2.0
Increase EAPOL startWhen to 2 for the case where the AP/GO has
advertised it supports WPS 2.0. This is done to make it less likely for
the EAPOL-Start frame to be sent out since that is only required for WPS
1.0. Not sending it can remove one unnecessary round trip from the EAP
exchange when the AP is going to start with EAP-Request/Identity
immediately based on the Association Request frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-13 12:24:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
54a800dd51 netlink: Fix RTM_SETLINK padding at the end of the message
While the kernel seems to have accepted the message to set linkmode and
operstate without the final attribute getting padded to 32-bit length,
it is better to get this cleaned up to match expected format. The double
NLMSG_ALIGN() followed by RTA_LENGTH() did not make much sense here.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-12 19:27:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3eafc494d8 Fix CONFIG_NO_SCAN_PROCESSING=y build
ht_supported() was used but not defined in such a case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-12 17:02:23 +03:00
Toby Gray
3cea004d3c Make wpa_ctrl_get_remote_ifname declaration conditional.
The definition of wpa_ctrl_get_remote_ifname is conditional on
CONFIG_CTRL_IFACE_UDP. This change makes the header declaration of
this function also conditional on the same define.

Signed-off-by: Toby Gray <toby.gray@realvnc.com>
2014-10-12 16:51:02 +03:00
Toby Gray
f5c649b769 Fix warning about unused parameter if CONFIG_DEBUG_FILE is not defined.
This change adds a cast to void to indicate that the path parameter is
unused when CONFIG_DEBUG_FILE is not defined. This fixes a compiler
warning about unused parameters.

Signed-off-by: Toby Gray <toby.gray@realvnc.com>
2014-10-12 16:49:12 +03:00
Jean Trivelly
4b32f6a5ec P2P: Inform upper layer when WFD-IE field of a P2P device has changed
When WFD IE of a P2P device changes, the field is locally updated in P2P
supplicant but upper layer is not informed about this change.

Signed-off-by: Jean Trivelly <jean.trivelly@intel.com>
2014-10-12 16:34:24 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
07e2de3193 wpa_supplicant: Allow OpenSSL cipherlist string to be configured
The new openssl_cipher configuration parameter can be used to select
which TLS cipher suites are enabled for TLS-based EAP methods when
OpenSSL is used as the TLS library. This parameter can be used both as a
global parameter to set the default for all network blocks and as a
network block parameter to override the default for each network
profile.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-12 11:55:13 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f8995f8f1c hostapd: Allow OpenSSL cipherlist string to be configured
The new openssl_cipher configuration parameter can be used to select
which TLS cipher suites are enabled when hostapd is used as an EAP
server with OpenSSL as the TLS library.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-12 11:52:05 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b7328434f7 OpenSSL: Add a mechanism to configure cipher suites
This extends the TLS wrapper code to allow OpenSSL cipherlist string to
be configured. In addition, the default value is now set to
DEFAULT:!EXP:!LOW to ensure cipher suites with low and export encryption
algoriths (40-64 bit keys) do not get enabled in default configuration
regardless of how OpenSSL build was configured.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-12 11:45:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7c0e5b58f9 DFS: Check os_get_random() result
This use does not really need a strong random number, so fall back to
os_random() if a theoretical error case occurs. (CID 72682)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 19:43:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
24661bbadc AP: Check os_get_random() return value more consistently
While this specific case does not really care what value is used, the
the theoretical error case can be handled more consistently. (CID 72684)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 19:43:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8c5dfc79a5 EAP-MSCHAPv2 server: Check ms_funcs results more consistently
This makes the code more consistent by checking the somewhat theoretical
error cases more consistently (CID 72685).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 19:43:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
08ef4426a7 EAP-IKEv2: Fix the payload parser
The payload lengths were not properly verified and the first check on
there being enough buffer for the header was practically ignored. The
second check for the full payload would catch length issues, but this is
only after the potential read beyond the buffer. (CID 72687)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 19:22:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
683b408a9e WPS UPnP: Check os_get_random() result more consistently
While the value here would not matter much, make the implementation more
consistent (CID 72692).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 19:08:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e7b96ecdb3 TLS client: Make DH parameter parsing easier for static analyzers
The dh_p_len, dh_g_len, and dh_ys_len parameters were validated against
the received message structure, but that did not seem to be done in a
way that some static analyzers would understand this (CID 72699).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 19:04:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
92b5b371b6 WPS UPnP: Check os_get_random() result
This makes the implementation more consistent (CID 72705).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:58:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
533d7fb7b7 MACsec: Check os_get_random() return value
This makes the MACsec implementation more consistent with rest of
wpa_supplicant. (CID 72677, CID 72695, CID 72701, CID 72709, CID 72711)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:54:43 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
93da049851 nl80211: Be more consistent with linux_set_iface_flags() result
Check the return value and write a debug message if this operation
failes (CID 74146).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:43:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6c9f74deaf EAP-PAX server: Remove unused assignment
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:14:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
918bd0fe78 EAP-SIM DB: Remove unused assignment
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:13:32 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6f577c5e45 EAP-FAST server: Remove unused assignment
Commit e8c08c9a36 ('EAP-FAST server: Fix
potential read-after-buffer (by one byte)') changed the while loop
design in a way that does not require the pos variable to be updated
anymore. Remove that unneeded code to clean up static analyzer warnings
about unused assignments.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:11:14 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e9471493ef EAP-FAST server: Remove unused write
next_type is not used in case m->check() results in ignoring the packet.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:10:27 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
58b992489c RADIUS: Remove unused write
There is no need to update the left variable when breaking out from the
loop.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:06:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4aa01d38f5 IAPP: Avoid warnings on unused write
The hlen and len variables are identical here, but only the hlen was
used in the end. Change this to use the len variable to avoid
unnecessary static analyzer warnings about unused writes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 18:03:38 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
01b3bbfc66 test: Remove driver_test.c
The driver_test.c driver wrapper (-Dtest in wpa_supplicant and
driver=test in hostapd) was previously used for testing without real
Wi-Fi hardware. mac80211_hwsim-based tests have practically replaced all
these needs and there has been no improvements or use for driver_test.c
in a long while. Because of this, there has not really been any effort
to maintain this older test tool and no justification to change this
either. Remove the obsoleted test mechanism to clean up the repository.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 17:46:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e41e4f9ee3 Simplify memory allocation/freeing for static analyzers
It looks like the use of sm->wpa == WPA_VERSION_WPA2 in two locations
within the function was a bit too much for clang static analyzer to
understand. Use a separate variable for storing the allocated memory so
that it can be freed unconditionally. The kde variable can point to
either stack memory or temporary allocation, but that is now const
pointer to make the design clearer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 17:29:50 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f4452cc2b1 Add a workaround to clanc static analyzer warning
dl_list_del() followed by dl_list_add() seemed to confuse clang static
analyzer somehow, so explicitly check for the prev pointer to be
non-NULL to avoid an incorrect warning.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 17:18:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3e9fa3be62 WPS UPnP: Make dl_list_first() use easier for static analyzer
The preceding dl_list_len() check guarantees that dl_list_first()
returns an entry and not NULL. However, that seems to be a bit too
difficult path to follow for static analyzers, so add an explicit check
for the dl_list_first() return value to be non-NULL to avoid warnings.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 13:45:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e635efb407 P2P: Clean up coding style and indentation level
The multi-line for loop body and incorrect indentation level on the
return statement looked pretty confusing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-11 12:05:27 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
59d7148ad7 nl80211: Provide subtype and reason code for AP SME drivers
This allows drivers that implement AP SME internally to generate a
Deauthentication or Disassociation frame with the specified reason code.
This was already done with drivers that use hostapd/wpa_supplicant for
AP SME.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-10 20:05:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9d4ff04af3 Add external EAPOL transmission option for testing purposes
The new ext_eapol_frame_io parameter can be used to configure hostapd
and wpa_supplicant to use control interface for receiving and
transmitting EAPOL frames. This makes it easier to implement automated
test cases for protocol testing. This functionality is included only in
CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-10 18:40:57 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
61fc90483f P2P: Handle improper WPS termination on GO during group formation
A P2P Client may be able to connect to the GO even if the WPS
provisioning step has not terminated cleanly (e.g., P2P Client does not
send WSC_Done). Such group formation attempt missed the event
notification about started group on the GO and also did not set the
internal state corresponding to the successful group formation.

This commit addresses the missing part by completing GO side group
formation on a successful first data connection if WPS does not complete
cleanly. Also, this commit reorders the STA authorization indications to
ensure that the group formation success notification is given prior to
the first STA connection to handle such scenarios.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-10 18:40:57 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
51465a0b5c The master branch is now used for v2.4 development
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-09 20:36:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
724fce8fff Change version information for the 2.3 release
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-09 17:41:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2b28ef6ca8 browser-wpadebug: Use more robust mechanism for starting browser
Use os_exec() to run the external browser to avoid undesired command
line processing for control interface event strings. Previously, it
could have been possible for some of the event strings to include
unsanitized data which is not suitable for system() use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-09 17:38:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3d8a3ffcf0 browser-android: Use more robust mechanism for starting browser
Use os_exec() to run the external browser to avoid undesired command
line processing for control interface event strings. Previously, it
could have been possible for some of the event strings to include
unsanitized data which is not suitable for system() use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-09 17:38:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
17dc39a8bc browser-system: Use more robust mechanism for starting browser
Use os_exec() to run the external browser to avoid undesired command
line processing for control interface event strings. Previously, it
could have been possible for some of the event strings to include
unsanitized data which is not suitable for system() use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-09 17:38:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
89de07a944 Add os_exec() helper to run external programs
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-09 17:38:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4a274f487a DFS: Allow 80+80 MHz be configured for VHT
This allows cases where neither 80 MHz segment requires DFS to be
configured. DFS CAC operation itself does not yet support 80+80, though,
so if either segment requires DFS, the AP cannot be brought up.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-09 14:25:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d5fe4e6c18 Reserve QCA vendor specific nl80211 commands 34..49
These are reserved for QCA use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-07 20:08:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a256506ddc AES: Extend key wrap implementation to support longer data
This extends the "XOR t" operation in aes_wrap() and aes_unwrap() to
handle up to four octets of the n*h+i value instead of just the least
significant octet. This allows the plaintext be longer than 336 octets
which was the previous limit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-07 14:57:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
eefec1e40b AES: Extend key wrap design to support longer AES keys
This adds kek_len argument to aes_wrap() and aes_unwrap() functions and
allows AES to be initialized with 192 and 256 bit KEK in addition to
the previously supported 128 bit KEK.

The test vectors in test-aes.c are extended to cover all the test
vectors from RFC 3394.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-07 14:57:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
98a1571d88 OpenSSL: Clean up one part from the BoringSSL patch
The (int) typecast I used with sk_GENERAL_NAME_num() to complete the
BoringSSL compilation was not really the cleanest way of doing this.
Update that to use stack_index_t variable to avoid this just like the
other sk_*_num() calls.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-07 11:49:20 +03:00
Adam Langley
a8572960a9 Support building with BoringSSL
BoringSSL is Google's cleanup of OpenSSL and an attempt to unify
Chromium, Android and internal codebases around a single OpenSSL.

As part of moving Android to BoringSSL, the wpa_supplicant maintainers
in Android requested that I upstream the change. I've worked to reduce
the size of the patch a lot but I'm afraid that it still contains a
number of #ifdefs.

[1] https://www.imperialviolet.org/2014/06/20/boringssl.html

Signed-off-by: Adam Langley <agl@chromium.org>
2014-10-07 01:18:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a61fcc131a Clean up authenticator PMKSA cache implementation
This makes the implementation somewhat easier to understand.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 23:01:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
cb129db34c Clear PMKSA cache entry data when freeing them
Avoid leaving the PMK information unnecessarily in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 23:01:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8c8d26aada Remove unnecessary PMKSA cache freeing step
_pmksa_cache_free_entry() is a static function that is never called with
entry == NULL, so there is no need to check for that.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 23:01:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9c829900bb Fix authenticator OKC fetch from PMKSA cache to avoid infinite loop
If the first entry in the PMKSA cache did not match the station's MAC
address, an infinite loop could be reached in pmksa_cache_get_okc() when
trying to find a PMKSA cache entry for opportunistic key caching cases.
This would only happen if OKC is enabled (okc=1 included in the
configuration file).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 23:01:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
47ea24c13d Fix PMKSA cache timeout from Session-Timeout in WPA/WPA2 cases
Previously, WPA/WPA2 case ended up using the hardcoded
dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime (43200 seconds) for PMKSA cache entries
instead of using the Session-Timeout value from the RADIUS server (if
included in Access-Accept). Store a copy of the Session-Timeout value
and use it instead of the default value so that WPA/WPA2 cases get the
proper timeout similarly to non-WPA/WPA2 cases.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 23:01:08 +03:00
Janusz Dziedzic
4ec68377ef wpa_supplicant: Use hostapd_freq_params in assoc_params
Use hostapd_freq_params instead of simple frequency parameter for driver
commands. This is preparation for IBSS configuration to allow use of
HT/VHT in IBSS.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2014-10-04 18:43:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
43f02e6ad7 wpa_ctrl: Update wpa_ctrl_recv() documentation for non-block behavior
Commit 4fdc8def88 changed the wpa_ctrl
socket to be be non-blocking, so the comment about wpa_ctrl_recv()
blocking is not valid anymore.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 18:32:57 +03:00
Dan Williams
3e0272ca00 nl80211: Re-read MAC address on RTM_NEWLINK
Commit 97279d8d (after hostap-2.0) dropped frame events from foreign
addresses. Unfortunately this commit did not handle the case where the
interface's MAC address might be changed externally, which other
wpa_supplicant code already handled. This causes the driver to reject
any MLME event because the address from the event doesn't match the
stale address in the driver data.

Changing an interface's MAC address requires that the interface be
down, the change made, and then the interface brought back up. This
triggers an RTM_NEWLINK event which driver_nl80211.c can use to
re-read the MAC address of the interface.

Signed-hostap: Dan Williams <dcbw@redhat.com>
2014-10-04 16:41:20 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5dfbd725a9 nl80211: Add get_bss_ifindex() helper
This can be used to fetch a BSS entry based on interface index.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-04 16:21:03 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
08d7665c6b TDLS: Use WMM IE for propagating peer WMM capability
Relying on qos qosinfo is not enough, as it can be 0 for WMM enabled
peers that don't support U-APSD. Further, some peers don't even contain
this IE (Google Nexus 5), but do contain the WMM IE during setup.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-10-03 11:52:56 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
17729b0985 TDLS: Fix concurrent setup test for mac80211 drivers
A recent mac80211 patch ("8f02e6b mac80211: make sure TDLS peer STA
exists during setup") forces the TDLS STA to exist before sending any
mgmt packets. Add the STA before sending a concurrent-setup test packet.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-10-03 11:52:27 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
984dadc23a TDLS: Set the initiator during tdls_mgmt operations
Some drivers need to know the initiator of a TDLS connection in order
to generate a correct TDLS mgmt packet. It is used to determine
the link identifier IE. Pass this information to the driver.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-10-03 11:52:21 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
01cb5df20c Sync with wireless-testing.git include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h
This brings in nl80211 definitions as of 2014-10-02.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-10-03 11:39:27 +03:00
Ilan Peer
ca3c6b4da7 nl80211: Fix compatibility with older version of libnl
Commit 97ed9a06df ('nl80211: Remove bridge
FDB entry upon sta_remove()') used nl_sock and nl_socket_* functions
which are not compatible with older versions of libnl. Fix this.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-10-03 11:34:51 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d76426c3aa TDLS: Filter AID value properly for VHT peers
IEEE 802.11 standard sends AID in a field that is defined in a bit
strange way to set two MSBs to ones. That is not the real AID and those
extra bits need to be filtered from the value before passing this to the
driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-10-01 19:58:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1cbdb9d137 Add helper function for generating random MAC addresses with same OUI
random_mac_addr_keep_oui() is similar to random_mac_addr(), but it
maintains the OUI part of the source address.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-30 00:40:23 +03:00
Kyeyoon Park
97ed9a06df nl80211: Remove bridge FDB entry upon sta_remove()
The FDB entry removal ensures that the traffic destined for a
disassociated station's MAC address is no longer forwarded from the
bridge to the BSS.

Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-29 13:10:13 +03:00
Kyeyoon Park
39323bc16a AP: hostapd_setup_bss() code clean-up
Signed-off-by: Kyeyoon Park <kyeyoonp@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-29 13:10:13 +03:00
Ahmad Masri
1595eb93ae P2P: Add support for 60 GHz social channel
Support 60 GHz band in P2P module by selecting random social channel
from all supported social channels in 2.4 GHz and 60 GHz bands.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-29 12:01:46 +03:00
Philippe De Swert
375f4a3b5a hostapd: Avoid dead code with P2P not enabled
In case P2P is not enabled the if (dev_addr) is always ignored as
dev_addr will be NULL. As this code is relevant only to P2P, it can be
moved to be the ifdef to avoid static analyzer warnings. (CID 72907)

Signed-off-by: Philippe De Swert <philippe.deswert@jollamobile.com>
2014-09-28 20:47:06 +03:00
Bernhard Walle
a8833b84f4 util: Don't use "\e"
'\e' representing ESC (0x1b) is not C standard, it's an GNU extension.
https://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Character-Escapes.html#Character-Escapes

Since the code also compiles on Windows with Microsoft compiler, we
should use '\033' instead.

Note: I didn't try to build the whole wpa_supplicant on Windows, so I
don't know if it still builds (I have no Visual Studio 2005 for a quick
test). I just needed the string conversion routines for the P"" syntax
in both directions.

Signed-off-by: Bernhard Walle <bernhard@bwalle.de>
2014-09-28 19:16:32 +03:00
Stefan Lippers-Hollmann
8c6f4a5a50 ap_config.c: fix typo for "capabilities"
Signed-off-by: Stefan Lippers-Hollmann <s.l-h@gmx.de>
2014-09-28 11:03:48 +03:00
Constantin Musca
7139cf4a4f P2P: Decrement sd_pending_bcast_queries when sd returns success
The sd_pending_bcast_queries variable should be decremented only
in case of success. This way, the supplicant can retry if a service
discovery request fails.

Signed-off-by: Constantin Musca <constantin.musca@intel.com>
2014-09-28 11:03:48 +03:00
Janusz Dziedzic
dbdc9a1d48 nl80211: Fix memory leak on start radar detection error path
Free nlmsg if failing to start radar detection.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2014-09-28 11:03:48 +03:00
Janusz Dziedzic
ed8e005973 hostap: nl80211 use nl80211_put_freq_params
Use nl80211_put_freq_params when it possible. Remove
duplicated code.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2014-09-27 21:47:40 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4d8fb63799 Add helper function for generating random MAC addresses
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-27 19:12:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
fee354c74d nl80211: Add command for changing local MAC address
This can be used to allow wpa_supplicant to control local MAC address
for connections.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-27 19:11:24 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e49cabcf87 P2P: Set timeout when starting GO Negotiation from Probe Req RX
It was possible for the p2p_go_neg_start timeout handler to get called
when there was a pending timeout from an earlier GO Negotiation start.
This could result in that old timeout expiring too early for the newly
started GO Negotiation to complete. Avoid such issues by setting a
sufficiently long timeout here just before triggering the new GO
Negotiation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-27 16:12:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7549c178ac P2P: Clear pending_listen_freq when starting GO Neg/Invite
Previously, it was possible for the p2p->pending_listen_freq to be left
at non-zero value if Probe Request frame was received from a peer with
which we were waiting to start GO Negotiation/Invite process. That could
result in the following Listen operation getting blocked in some
operation sequences if the peer did not acknowledge the following P2P
Public Action frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-27 16:12:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b497a21267 nl80211: Ignore auth/assoc events when testing driver-SME
Previously, extra connect/roam events were ignored when user space SME
was used to avoid confusing double events for association. However,
there was no matching code for ignoring auth/assoc events when using
driver SME. Such events would not normally show up since the driver SME
case would not generated them. However, when testing forced connect
command with force_connect_cmd=1 driver param, these events are
indicated.

Ignore the extra events in testing cases to make the hwsim test cases
match more closely the real code path for driver SME. In addition, this
resolves some test case failures where double association event could
end up causing a failure, e.g., when doing PMKSA caching in
pmksa_cache_oppurtunistic_connect.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-27 16:12:41 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
c53a9bf818 Check for driver's DFS offload capability before handling DFS
This fixes couple of code paths where the WPA_DRIVER_FLAGS_DFS_OFFLOAD
flag was not checked properly and unexpected DFS operations were
initiated (and failed) in case the driver handles all these steps.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-22 16:50:28 +03:00
Dan Williams
7a4a93b959 dbus: Add SignalPoll() method to report current signal properties
Analogous to the control interface's SIGNAL_POLL request.

Signed-hostap: Dan Williams <dcbw@redhat.com>
2014-09-13 17:21:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
df2508d7a8 P2P: Check os_get_random() return value more consistently
In theory, this call could fail, so check the return value before using
the received data. These specific cases would not really care much about
the failures, but this keeps the code more consistent and keeps static
analyzer warnings more useful. (CID 72678, CID 72679, CID 72680,
CID 72683, CID 72689, CID 72698, CID 72703)

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-13 16:27:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
54461f3e03 RADIUS server: Remove unreachable code
The previous break will already stop the loop, so this unnecessary check
can be removed (CID 72708).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-13 16:22:16 +03:00
Darshan Paranji Sri
e4474c1c20 FT: Fix hostapd with driver-based SME to authorize the STA
The driver-based SME case did not set STA flags properly to the kernel
in the way that hostapd-SME did in ieee802_11.c. This resulted in the FT
protocol case not marking the STA entry authorized. Fix that by handling
the special WLAN_AUTH_FT case in hostapd_notif_assoc() and also add the
forgotten hostapd_set_sta_flags() call to synchronize these flag to the
driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-12 18:46:56 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0800f9ee6c nl80211: Add roaming policy update using QCA vendor command
This allows updating roaming policy for drivers that select the BSS
internally so that wpa_supplicant (based on bssid parameter
configuration) and the driver remain in sync.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-11 15:59:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0ef023e478 Add support for driver command to update roaming policy
The network block bssid parameter can be used to force a specific BSS to
be used for a connection. It is also possible to modify this parameter
during an association. Previously, that did not result in any
notification to the driver which was somewhat problematic with drivers
that take care of BSS selection. Add a new mechanism to allow
wpa_supplicant to provide a driver update if the bssid parameter change
for the current connection modifies roaming policy (roaming
allowed/disallowed within ESS).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-11 15:59:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0cd9846c63 nl80211: Print debug info on STA flag changes
This makes it easier to follow how kernel STA flags are managed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-11 11:25:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
17e2091279 P2P: Fix radio work issue with wait-for-peer GO Negotiation
If a TX status event and RX event for a GO Negotiation frame gets
delayed long enough to miss the initial wait, it was possible for
reception of a GO Negotiation Response frame with status 1 to try to
initiate a new p2p-listen work item to wait for the peer to become ready
while a previous p2p-listen was already in progress due to that earlier
timeout while waiting for peer. This would result in the new
start_listen request getting rejected ("P2P: Reject start_listen since
p2p_listen_work already exists") and the negotiation not proceeding.

Work around this by using P2P_WAIT_PEER_CONNECT state instead of
P2P_WAIT_PEER_IDLE if P2P_CONNECT_LISTEN state has already been entered
when processing this special GO Negotiation Response status=1 case. This
can avoid double-scheduling of p2p-listen and as such, completion of the
GO negotiation even if the driver event or peer response are not
received in time (the response is supposed to be there within 100 ms per
spec, but there are number of deployed devices that do not really meet
this requirement).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-09 18:00:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b08d5fa793 WPS: Set EAPOL workarounds dynamically based on association
Previously, the shorter startWhen value was used based on build
parameters (i.e., if WPS was enabled). This is not really ideal and the
knowledge of WPS use can be provided to the EAPOL state machine to allow
this (and similar WPS workarounds) to be done only when the association
is for the purpose of WPS.

Reduce the default startWhen value from 3 to 2 seconds for non-WPS case
since WPS builds have likely received most testing for the past years
with the 1 second value and there is no strong justification for forcing
the longer 3 second wait should a frame be lost or something else
require the EAPOL-Start to initiate operation after a connection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-08 17:16:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8511a0f67b WPS: Extend internal entropy pool help for key/snonce derivation
The internal entropy pool was previously used to prevent 4-way handshake
in AP mode from completing before sufficient entropy was available to
allow secure keys to be generated. This commit extends that workaround
for boards that do not provide secure OS level PRNG (e.g., /dev/urandom
does not get enough entropy) for the most critical WPS operations by
rejecting AP-as-enrollee case (use of AP PIN to learn/modify AP
configuration) and new PSK/passphrase generation. This does not have any
effect on devices that have an appropriately working OS level PRNG
(e.g., /dev/random and /dev/urandom on Linux).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-08 12:54:18 +03:00
Eduardo Abinader
3ee18569f5 nl80211: Register eloop after hs20 action frame
Even when hs20 action frame is unable to be registered,
for whatever reason, it should be possible to register
event handle for received driver messages. This patch also
avoids a segmentation fault, when p2p and hs20 were enabled
and GO NEG was unable to create p2p iface, the destroy eloop
was crashing by reading an invalid handle.

Signed-off-by: Eduardo Abinader <eduardo.abinader@openbossa.org>
2014-09-07 19:22:49 +03:00
Masashi Honma
5c61d214ad openssl: Fix memory leak in openssl ec deinit
Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-09-07 19:14:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3a413e0ed8 RADIUS client: Check getsockname() return value
In theory, this function could fail, so check the return value before
printing out the RADIUS local address debug message (CID 72700).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-07 18:35:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9c196f7703 HTTP: Fix OCSP status check
Due to a missing curly brackets, the OCSP status checking was not
working in the expected way. Instead of allowing optional-OCSP
configuration to accept connection when OCSP response was ready, all
such cases were marked as hard failures. In addition, the debug prints
were not necessarily accurate for the mandatory-OCSP-but-no-response
case (CID 72694, CID 72704).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-07 18:30:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c9cd78e5a1 RADIUS server: Fix IPv6 radiusAuthClientAddress mask
Incorrect buffer was used when writing the IPv6 mask for RADIUS server
MIB information (CID 72707).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-07 18:25:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6473e80ea4 EAP-PAX server: Add explicit CID length limit
Instead of using implicit limit based on 16-bit unsigned integer having
a maximum value of 65535, limit the maximum length of a CID explicitly
to 1500 bytes. This will hopefully help in reducing false warnings from
static analyzers (CID 72712).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-07 17:10:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6a6566c7af Remove unnecessarily shadowed local variable
The same local X509 *cert variable can be used for both the X509_dup()
calls.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-09-07 16:40:33 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
e47abdb9db TDLS: Decline Setup Request with status code 37 if BSSID does not match
TDLS Setup Request frame has to be rejected with status code 37 ("The
request has been declined"), if the BSSID in the received Link
Identifier does not match the current BSSID per IEEE Std 802.11-2012,
10.22.4 ('TDLS direct-link establishment') step (b). The previously used
status code 7 ('Not in same BSS') is described to used only when
processing TPK Handshake Message 2 in TDLS Setup Response frame.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-02 18:06:58 +03:00
Mahesh A Saptasagar
ce2002acca TDLS: Add RSN and Timeout interval IEs in TDLS Discovery Response frame
If RSN is enabled, add RSN and Timeout interval elements in TDLS
Discovery Response frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-02 17:11:42 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f2e9083549 nl80211: Add more RTM_NEWLINK/DELLINK debug messages
This makes it easier to figure out what operations are generating each
RTM_DELLINK message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-01 16:18:01 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
728ff2f469 nl80211: Fix RTM_DELLINK processing for bridge events
When a netdev is removed from a bridge, RTM_DELLINK message is received
with ifname (IFLA_IFNAME) pointing to the main netdev event though that
netdev is not deleted. This was causing issues with P2P GO interface
getting disabled when the netdev was removed from a bridge. Fix this by
filtering RTM_DELLINK events that are related to the bridge when
indicating interface status changes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-09-01 16:14:07 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
04a258e7c5 hostapd: Check that EVENT_ASSOC data is present before using it
While hostapd should not really receive the EVENT_ASSOC message for
IBSS, driver_nl80211.c could potentially generate that if something
external forces the interface into IBSS mode and the IBSS case does not
provide the struct assoc_info data. Avoid the potential NULL pointer
dereference by explicitly verifying for the event data to be present.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-08-26 17:23:02 +03:00
Avinash Patil
b8d87ed296 nl80211: Disable Probe Request reporting for static AP during deinit
Disable Probe Request reporting for statically created AP interfaces
during de-initialization. We will enable it again while starting AP
operations.

Signed-off-by: Avinash Patil <avinashapatil@gmail.com>
2014-08-10 11:22:30 +03:00
Avinash Patil
bf144cf649 nl80211: Do not change iftype for static AP interface
Some devices have limitations which do not allow changing virtual
interface mode from AP to station or vice versa. To work around this,
check if such AP interface is not dynamic. If such an interface is
enumarated, just set ifmode to AP and avoid setting nlmode to default
station mode on deinit.

Signed-off-by: Avinash Patil <avinashapatil@gmail.com>
2014-08-10 11:19:11 +03:00
Jean-Marie Lemetayer
61157afb1c wext: Add signal_poll callback
Add a basic implementation of a signal_poll callback for wext drivers.

Signed-off-by: Jean-Marie Lemetayer <jeanmarie.lemetayer@gmail.com>
2014-08-10 11:07:05 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6c460eaf7e Add RSN cipher/AKM suite attributes into RADIUS messages
This adds hostapd support for the new WLAN-Pairwise-Cipher,
WLAN-Group-Cipher, WLAN-AKM-Suite, and WLAN-Group-Mgmt-Pairwise-Cipher
attributes defined in RFC 7268. These attributes are added to RADIUS
messages when the station negotiates use of WPA/RSN.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-31 19:55:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
cdffd72173 Add WLAN-HESSID into RADIUS messages
This adds hostapd support for the new WLAN-HESSID attribute defined in
RFC 7268. This attribute contains the HESSID and it is added whenever
Interworking is enabled and HESSID is configured.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-31 19:55:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
69002fb0a8 Add Mobility-Domain-Id into RADIUS messages
This adds hostapd support for the new Mobility-Domain-Id attribute
defined in RFC 7268. This attribute contains the mobility domain id and
it is added whenever the station negotiates use of FT.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-31 19:55:29 +03:00
Elliott Hughes
ec5357323c Android: Always #include <sys/...>, not <linux/...>
Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2014-07-31 16:59:23 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e8c08c9a36 EAP-FAST server: Fix potential read-after-buffer (by one byte)
The special PAC_OPAQUE_TYPE_PAD case did not skip incrementing of the
pos pointer and could result in one octet read-after-buffer when parsing
the PAC-Opaque data.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-26 21:14:05 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
27a725cf74 EAP: Do not allow fast session resumption with different network block
This forces EAP peer implementation to drop any possible fast resumption
data if the network block for the current connection is not the same as
the one used for the previous one. This allows different network blocks
to be used with non-matching parameters to enforce different rules even
if the same authentication server is used. For example, this allows
different CA trust rules to be enforced with different ca_cert
parameters which can prevent EAP-TTLS Phase 2 from being used based on
TLS session resumption.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-26 19:39:13 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
905c7223b1 Add wpa_msg_global_ctrl()
This is similar to wpa_msg_global() in the same way as wpa_msg_ctrl() is
to wpa_msg(). In other words, wpa_msg_global_ctrl() is used to send
global control interface events without printing them into the debug
log.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-26 13:04:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1f1fe195cd EAP-pwd: Clear identity string and temporary buffer explicitly
Use an explicit memset call to clear any configuration parameter and
dynamic data that contains private information like keys or identity.
This brings in an additional layer of protection by reducing the length
of time this type of private data is kept in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-24 20:12:57 +03:00
Florent Daigniere
f119d66942 EAP-pwd: Verify BN_rand_range return code
This makes the EAP-pwd server and peer implementations more robust
should OpenSSL fail to derive random number for some reason. While this
is unlikely to happen in practice, the implementation better be prepared
for this should something unexpected ever happen. See
http://jbp.io/2014/01/16/openssl-rand-api/#review-of-randbytes-callers
for more details.

Signed-off-by: Florent Daigniere <nextgens@freenetproject.org>
2014-07-24 19:42:44 +03:00
Florent Daigniere
5197f0335c EAP-pwd: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Florent Daigniere <nextgens@freenetproject.org>
2014-07-24 19:39:44 +03:00
Florent Daigniere
26c10f797c OpenSSL: Use EC_POINT_clear_free instead of EC_POINT_free
This changes OpenSSL calls to explicitly clear the EC_POINT memory
allocations when freeing them. This adds an extra layer of security by
avoiding leaving potentially private keys into local memory after they
are not needed anymore. While some of these variables are not really
private (e.g., they are sent in clear anyway), the extra cost of
clearing them is not significant and it is simpler to just clear these
explicitly rather than review each possible code path to confirm where
this does not help.

Signed-off-by: Florent Daigniere <nextgens@freenetproject.org>
2014-07-24 19:35:07 +03:00
Florent Daigniere
3248071dc3 OpenSSL: Use BN_clear_free instead of BN_free
This changes OpenSSL calls to explicitly clear the bignum memory
allocations when freeing them. This adds an extra layer of security by
avoiding leaving potentially private keys into local memory after they
are not needed anymore. While some of these variables are not really
private (e.g., they are sent in clear anyway), the extra cost of
clearing them is not significant and it is simpler to just clear these
explicitly rather than review each possible code path to confirm where
this does not help.

Signed-off-by: Florent Daigniere <nextgens@freenetproject.org>
2014-07-24 19:28:39 +03:00
Dmitry Shmidt
870dfe9932 EAP-TTLS: Remove FreeRADIUS workaround for EAP-TTLS/MSCHAPv2
FreeRADIUS releases before 1.1.4 did not send MS-CHAP2-Success in
EAP-TTLS/MSCHAPv2. A wpa_supplicant workaround for that was added in
2005 and it has been enabled by default to avoid interoperability
issues. This could be disabled with all other EAP workarounds
(eap_workaround=0). However, that will disable some workarounds that are
still needed with number of authentication servers.

Old FreeRADIUS versions should not be in use anymore, so it makes sense
to remove this EAP-TTLS/MSCHAPv2 workaround completely to get more
complete validation of server behavior. This allows MSCHAPv2 to verify
that the server knows the password instead of relying only on the TLS
certificate validation.

Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2014-07-20 10:20:24 +03:00
Cedric IZOARD
6d00ab0430 nl80211: Ensure nl_preq unregistration on driver deinit
When driver interface is destroyed (via wpa_driver_nl80211_deinit) the
"preq" nl socket isn't always deleted but the callback struct associated
is. After the interface is destroyed we may still get event on the
socket but as the callback has been freed this will cause wpa_supplicant
to crash.

This patch ensures that the "preq" socket is destroyed when destroying
the interface.

Signed-off-by: Cedric IZOARD <cedricx.izoard@intel.com>
2014-07-08 16:01:43 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
71a0e395b9 P2P: Make unrecognized vendor elements available in P2P_PEER
This allows external programs to use vendor specific information from
P2P peers without wpa_supplicant having to be able to parse and
understand all such vendor specific elements.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-07-08 15:57:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
86bd36f0d5 Add generic mechanism for adding vendor elements into frames
This adds following new control interface commands to allow arbitrary
vendor elements to be added into number of frames:

VENDOR_ELEM_ADD <frame id> <hexdump of elem(s)>
VENDOR_ELEM_GET <frame id>
VENDOR_ELEM_REMOVE <frame id> <hexdump of elem(s)>
VENDOR_ELEM_REMOVE <frame id> *

The following frames are supported in this commit (additional frames can
be added in the future):

0 = Probe Request frame in P2P device discovery
1 = Probe Response frame from P2P Device role
2 = Probe Response frame from P2P GO
3 = Beacon frame from P2P GO
4 = PD Req
5 = PD Resp
6 = GO Neg Req
7 = GO Neg Resp
8 = GO Neg Conf
9 = Invitation Request
10 = Invitation Response
11 = P2P Association Request
12 = P2P Association Response

One or more vendor element can be added/removed with the commands. The
hexdump of the element(s) needs to contain the full element (id, len,
payload) and the buffer needs to pass IE parsing requirements to be
accepted.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-07-07 12:25:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c0e46bb7d4 DFS: Remove dead assignment
set_dfs_state() return value is not currently checked anywhere, so
remove the dead assignment to avoid static analyzer complaints.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-03 00:51:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
18389abcca WPS: Clear keys/PINs explicitly
Use an explicit memset call to clear any configuration parameter and
dynamic data that contains private information like keys or identity.
This brings in an additional layer of protection by reducing the length
of time this type of private data is kept in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:52:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b7175b4d02 Clear hostapd configuration keys explicitly
Use an explicit memset call to clear any hostapd configuration parameter
that contains private information like keys or identity. This brings in
an additional layer of protection by reducing the length of time this
type of private data is kept in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d1ecca6c15 HS 2.0 R2: Clear hs20-osu-client configuration keys explicitly
Use an explicit memset call to clear any hs20-osu-client configuration
parameter that contains private information like keys or identity. This
brings in an additional layer of protection by reducing the length of
time this type of private data is kept in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0a13e06bdb EAP server: Clear keying material on deinit
Reduce the amount of time keying material (MSK, EMSK, temporary private
data) remains in memory in EAP methods. This provides additional
protection should there be any issues that could expose process memory
to external observers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f534ee0804 EAP peer: Clear keying material on deinit
Reduce the amount of time keying material (MSK, EMSK, temporary private
data) remains in memory in EAP methods. This provides additional
protection should there be any issues that could expose process memory
to external observers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
19c48da06b Clear wpa_supplicant configuration keys explicitly
Use an explicit memset call to clear any wpa_supplicant configuration
parameter that contains private information like keys or identity. This
brings in an additional layer of protection by reducing the length of
time this type of private data is kept in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
28bfa29117 EAP-AKA: Remove unnecessary dead increment
The pos pointer is not used after this now nor in future plans, so no
need to increment the value. This remove a static analyzer warning about
dead increment.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
62493dff1b EAP-GPSK: Avoid dead increment by checking pos pointer
Instead of using the pre-calculated length of the buffer, determine the
length of used data based on the pos pointer. This avoids a static
analyzer warning about dead increment.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
164a453f9b FT: Debug print extra response data
This shows any extra data from FT response and also avoids a static
analyzer warning on dead increment.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
70bfc77161 PCSC: Debug print extra response data
This shows any extra data from USIM response and also avoids a static
analyzer warning on dead increment.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0233dcac5b SAE: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
34ef46ce54 WEP shared key: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3e4b77c9bd EAP-GTC: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a6eae3f7a1 EAP-MSCHAPv2: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
30411b351c EAP-TTLS: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a564d9ca36 EAP-MD5: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4685482552 EAP-PSK: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
cba0f8698b EAP-PEAP: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7b1e745870 EAP-LEAP: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8f92826b15 EAP-GPSK: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e1550d4be8 EAP-PAX: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c434503f5e EAP-FAST: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dddf7bbd4e EAP-EKE: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dfb5608139 EAP-SAKE: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
05c79d6acd EAP-SIM/AKA: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
675ddad1c2 EAP-IKEv2: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2049a3c874 TLS: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a79aea531e Milenage: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
05f916eeed AES-GCM: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
87a5c93bec AES-CCM: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7c24f53c88 EAPOL supplicant: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
870834a19b RSN authenticator: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0d15b69f0a RSN supplicant: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
72619ce61b MACsec: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c2371953f8 RADIUS: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ce9c9bcc38 WPS: Use os_memcmp_const() for hash/password comparisons
This makes the implementation less likely to provide useful timing
information to potential attackers from comparisons of information
received from a remote device and private material known only by the
authorized devices.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
afc3c8b07f Add constant time memory comparison function os_memcmp_const
This function is meant for comparing passwords or hash values where
difference in execution time could provide external observer information
about the location of the difference in the memory buffers. The return
value does not behave like os_memcmp(), i.e., os_memcmp_const() cannot
be used to sort items into a defined order. Unlike os_memcmp(),
execution time of os_memcmp_const() does not depend on the contents of
the compared memory buffers, but only on the total compared length.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ee352f1e5a EAP-pwd: Add explicit total length limit
Instead of using implicit limit based on 16-bit unsigned integer having
a maximum value of 65535, limit the maximum length of a fragmented
EAP-pwd message explicitly to 15000 bytes. None of the supported groups
use longer messages, so it is fine to reject any longer message without
even trying to reassemble it. This will hopefully also help in reducing
false warnings from static analyzers (CID 68124).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b2b8a4cb10 EAP-SIM/AKA: Pass EAP type as argument to eap_sim_msg_finish()
This makes it easier for static analyzers to figure out which code paths
are possible within eap_sim_msg_finish() for EAP-SIM. This will
hopefully avoid some false warnings (CID 68110, CID 68113, CID 68114).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f107d00cf6 PeerKey: Clean up EAPOL-Key Key Data processing
This extends the earlier commit e6270129f6
('Clean up EAPOL-Key Key Data processing') design to be used with
PeerKey EAPOL-key processing as well. This avoids false warnings from
static analyzer (CID 62860, CID 62861, CID 62862).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-07-02 12:38:46 +03:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
36716eef89 P2P: Add a utility function to run a method on every known peer
This will be useful in wpa_supplicant part to signal if a peer got its
group changed.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
2014-06-29 17:27:27 +03:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
bf035663c9 dbus: Remove GroupMember object type and use Peer instead
GroupMember is unusable in itself and all the necessary informations are
stored in Peer objects, thus replace the use of GroupMember by Peer.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
2014-06-29 17:19:12 +03:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
c6386e5c71 P2P Add a utility to run a callback on all available groups
This will be useful in wpa_supplicant to match group's SSIDs against a
specific one.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
2014-06-29 16:56:57 +03:00
Tomasz Bursztyka
8e76f48abd P2P: Add a utility function to get the group configuration
This will be useful for finding the interface related to this group
after formation based on the group SSID.

Signed-off-by: Tomasz Bursztyka <tomasz.bursztyka@linux.intel.com>
2014-06-29 16:52:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
37d8a27401 TDLS: Clean up add/set peer operations
Use a helper function to avoid multiple copies of the same long list of
argument parameters to wpa_sm_tdls_peer_addset() from the peer entry.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-29 13:44:15 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
bcd2baa0fa TDLS: Tear down connection on malformed Setup Confirm
Otherwise the peer will erroneously assume we have a working direct
link.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-29 13:44:14 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
81905409b5 TDLS: Abort local setup when failing to add STA
The driver might not always be able to add the new station. Abort the
setup when this happens.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-29 13:44:14 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
1dce7a216f TDLS: Update peer STA as soon as full peer info is available
Update the peer STA with full info sending TDLS Setup Response/Confirm
frames instead of after the full setup exchange. This makes it easier
for some drivers to properly negotiate QoS and HT information on the
direct link.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-29 13:44:14 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
819c943a3b TDLS: Remove peer from global peer-list on free
There is no need to keep the peer entry in memory after the link has
been removed.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
Tested-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-06-29 13:44:14 +03:00
Michal Kazior
5841958f26 hostapd: Use channel switch fallback on error
It's worth giving a try to fallback to re-starting BSSes at least once
hoping it works out instead of just leaving BSSes disabled.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-06-28 11:13:11 +03:00
Michal Kazior
8974620e3e hostapd: Perform multi-BSS CSA for DFS properly
Currently hostapd data structures aren't ready for multi-channel BSSes,
so make DFS work now at least with single-channel multi-BSS channel
switching.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-06-28 11:08:16 +03:00
Michal Kazior
6782b6846b hostapd: Move CSA parameters to hostapd_data
This prepares CSA structure and logic in hostapd for multi-BSS channel
switching.

Signed-hostap: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-06-28 11:02:39 +03:00
Christopher Wiley
3c5d34e30b Change channel before IBSS associations
Fix a bug where changing the mode of the interface to IBSS
fails because the interface is sitting on a channel where IBSS is
disallowed because of a previous association.

Signed-off-by: Christopher Wiley <wiley@chromium.org>
2014-06-28 10:46:33 +03:00
Christopher Wiley
ebffdbc493 nl80211: Refactor mode switch logic
In preparation for another wrinkle around switching into IBSS mode,
refactor existing mode switch logic for simplicity at the expense
of some brevity.

Signed-off-by: Christopher Wiley <wiley@chromium.org>
2014-06-28 10:42:05 +03:00
Pontus Fuchs
f95a4524c2 nl80211: Improve debug output by printing SA and DA in frames
Signed-off-by: Pontus Fuchs <pontus.fuchs@gmail.com>
2014-06-22 00:54:06 +03:00
Pontus Fuchs
dedfa440ed Print frame type name in debug output
"stype=4" becomes "stype=4 (WLAN_FC_STYPE_PROBE_REQ)" etc.

Signed-off-by: Pontus Fuchs <pontus.fuchs@gmail.com>
2014-06-22 00:51:39 +03:00
Johannes Berg
57a8f8af38 nl80211: Use low-priority scan for OBSS scan
Some drivers may support low-priority scans, if they do then
use that for OBSS scanning.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-06-22 00:47:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1b928f96b6 P2P: Allow passphrase length to be configured
Previously, eight character random passphrase was generated
automatically for P2P GO. The new p2p_passphrase_len parameter can be
used to increase this length to generate a stronger passphrase for cases
where practicality of manual configuration of legacy devices is not a
concern.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-22 00:15:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f3c6b230dd EAP-SIM': Fix AT_KDF parser to avoid infinite loop
Hitting maximum number of AT_KDF attributes could result in an infinite
loop due to the attribute parser not incrementing the current position
properly when skipping the extra KDF.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-21 12:20:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
79122f9f9c EAP-SIM/AKA: Remove unused RESULT_FAILURE state
This was not set anywhere, so remove the unnecessary code trying to
handle the unused state.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-21 00:26:29 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4075e2fe77 EAP-GPSK: Clean up CSuite_List length validation (CID 62854)
Use a local variable and size_t in length comparison to make this easier
for static analyzers to understand. In addition, set the return list and
list_len values at the end of the function, i.e., only in success case.
These do not change the actual behavior of the only caller for this
function, but clarifies what the helper function is doing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-18 17:14:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2dbc959699 EAP-FAST: Clean up TLV length validation (CID 62853)
Use size_t instead of int for storing and comparing the TLV length
against the remaining buffer length to make this easier for static
analyzers to understand.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-18 16:45:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
35cbadbb14 VHT: Remove useless validation code from Operating Mode Notification
This was added by commit 8a45811638
('hostapd: Add Operating Mode Notification support'), but the validation
steps cannot be true either for the channel width (which is a two-bit
subfield that cannot encode more than the list four values) or Rx NSS
(which cannot encode a value larger 7). Furthermore, the VHT_CHANWIDTH_*
defines do not match the definition of the Channel Width subfield
values.

Since this check cannot ever match, it is better to remove it to make
the code easier to understand and to avoid getting complaints about dead
code from static analyzers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-18 00:45:48 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
bed7eb6808 TDLS: Do not bail when failing to process IEs in Discovery Request
Some APs (Cisco) may tack on a weird IE to the end of a TDLS Discovery
Request packet. This needn't fail the response, since the required IEs
are verified separately.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-17 17:08:42 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
7e0f4f470a TDLS: Do not reject TPK M3 when failing to process IEs
Some APs (Cisco) may tack on a weird IE to the end of the TDLS confirm
packet, which can fail negotiation. As an interoperability workaround,
ignore IE parser failures and reject the frame only if any of the
mandatory IEs are not included.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-17 17:05:23 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7efc7f66b1 TDLS: Fix TPK M1 error case (CID 68214)
Commit 342bce63cd introduced a possibility
of a NULL pointer dereference on the error path if a new peer entry
fails to get added (i.e., memory allocation failure). Fix that by
skipping the wpa_tdls_peer_free() call if necessary.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-17 01:57:35 +03:00
Jithu Jance
d1bb7aeda4 nl80211: Fix non-hostapd interface addition to not call add_ifidx()
Commit b36935be1a ('nl80211: Fix EAPOL
frames not being delivered') and commit
147848ec4d ('nl80211: Do not add all
virtual interfaces to drv->if_indices') were not fully in sync and it
was possible for some non-hostapd use cases to end up adding undesired
ifindexes into the list of interfaces from which events and EAPOL frames
are processed on the parent interface. This could result, e.g., in P2P
Device management interface on getting unexpected events, including
RTM_NEWLINK event that could end up getting interpreted as an
indication of the interface being down and unavailable.

Make both add_ifidx() calls use the same criteria for adding interfaces
to the local list. This is not really a complete solution, but it is
good enough for now to fix the most visible side effects of this issue.

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2014-06-17 01:35:07 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
342bce63cd TDLS: Bail on STA add failure in tpk_m1 processing
The driver might not be able to add the TDLS STA. Fail if this happens.
Also fix the error path to always reset the TDLS peer data.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-16 23:36:42 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
947f900fb8 TDLS: Handle unreachable link teardown for external setup
If a link is unreachable, the specification mandates we should send a
teardown packet via the AP with a specific teardown reason. Force this
by first disabling the link and only then sending the teardown packet
for the LOW_ACK event.

Rename the TDLS LOW_ACK event handler to better reflect its purpose.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-06-16 23:34:06 +03:00
Amarnath Hullur Subramanyam
cf1600ace4 hostapd: Configure driver ACL even if MAC address list is empty
Earlier commit related to MAC address based access control list
offloaded to the driver was not sending ACL configuration to the driver
if the MAC address list was empty. Remove this check as empty access
control list is a valid use case and sending ACL parameters should not
be dependent on whether the list is empty.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-16 16:22:36 +03:00
Ilan Peer
e3bd6e9dc0 P2P: Use another interface operating channel as listen channel
Performing a P2P Device flow such as p2p_listen or
p2p_find, can degrade the performance of an active interface
connection, if the listen frequency is different than the
frequency used by that interface.

To reduce the effect of P2P Device flows on other interfaces,
try changing the listen channel of the P2P Device to match the
operating channel of one of the other active interfaces. This change
will be possible only in case that the listen channel is not forced
externally, and will be delayed to a point where the P2P Device
state machine is idle.

The optimization can be configured in the configuration file and
is disabled by default.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-06-15 00:46:11 +03:00
Ilan Peer
751b00ba28 P2P: Modify p2p_get_pref_freq
In p2p_get_pref_freq, if the channels argument is NULL, select a
preferred channel that is also one of the P2P Device configured
channels.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-06-15 00:21:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e6270129f6 Clean up EAPOL-Key Key Data processing
Use a single location in wpa_sm_rx_eapol() for preparing the pointer to
the Key Data field and to its validated length instead of fetching that
information in number of processing functions separately.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 19:02:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d56d7e56e3 Clean up EAPOL-Key processing
Re-order wpa_sm_rx_eapol() to first go through all EAPOL (802.1X) header
validation steps using the original message buffer and re-allocate and
copy the frame only if this is a valid EAPOL frame that contains an
EAPOL-Key. This makes the implementation easier to understand and saves
unnecessary memory allocations and copying should other types of EAPOL
frames get here.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 18:31:14 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8605eabd54 EAP-EKE: Fix typos in debug message
These error messages had an incorrect frame name (likely copy-pasted
from the commit message handler) and couple of typos.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 17:26:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ac79fcfa76 wext: Verify set_ssid results consistently (CID 62842)
Note in debug log if SSID clearing to stop pending cfg80211 association
attempts fail.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 12:32:53 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
305000e160 WPS: Check wps_build_wfa_ext() return value consistently (CID 68104)
While this call cannot really fail, check the return value to be more
consistent with all the other wps_build_wfa_ext() calls.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 12:32:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2485835ba3 EAP-MSCHAPv2: Check hash function results more consistently (CID 68105)
While the hash functions would be very unlikely to fail in practice,
they do have option of returning an error. Check that return value more
consistently.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 12:32:45 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b7c61c9d4e Fix validation of EAPOL-Key length with AES key wrap (CID 62859)
The additional eight octet field was removed from keydatalen without
proper validation of the Key Data Length field. It would have been
possible for an invalid EAPOL-Key frame to be processed in a way that
ends up reading beyond the buffer. In theory, this could have also
resulted in writing beyond the EAPOL-Key frame buffer, but that is
unlikely to be feasible due to the AES key wrap validation step on
arbitrary memory contents.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-14 00:20:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6590b6400f EAP-TNC: Limit maximum message buffer to 75000 bytes (CID 62873)
Since there is a limit on the EAP exchange due to maximum number of
roundtrips, there is no point in allowing excessively large buffers to
be allocated based on what the peer device claims the total message to
be. Instead, reject the message if it would not be possible to receive
it in full anyway.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-13 16:03:45 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
da995b2e11 WNM: Use cleaner way of generating pointer to a field (CID 68099)
The Action code field is in a fixed location, so the IEEE80211_HDRLEN
can be used here to clean up bounds checking to avoid false reports from
static analyzer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-13 00:27:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
062833c67c GAS server: Fix request frame length validation (CID 68098)
There seemed to be an off-by-one error in the validation of GAS request
frames. If a Public Action frame without the Action code field would
have reached this function, the length could have been passed as
(size_t) -1 which would likely have resulted in a crash due to reading
beyond the buffer. However, it looks like such frame would not be
delivered to hostapd at least with mac80211-based drivers. Anyway, this
function better be more careful with length validation should some other
driver end up reporting invalid Action frames.

In addition, the Action code field is in a fixed location, so the
IEEE80211_HDRLEN can be used here to clean up bounds checking to avoid
false reports from static analyzer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-13 00:27:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5ce3ae4c8f HT: Use cleaner way of generating pointer to a field (CID 68097)
The Action code field is in a fixed location, so the IEEE80211_HDRLEN
can be used here to clean up bounds checking to avoid false reports from
static analyzer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-13 00:27:15 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c02f35fb59 WPS: Clean up indentation level (CID 68109)
The implementation here was doing what it was supposed to, but the code
was indented in a way that made it quite confusing in the context of a
single line if statement body.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-12 19:45:31 +03:00
Philippe De Swert
68e2b8882a TNC: Fix minor memory leak (CID 62848)
In tncc_read_config(), the memory allocted for the config
did not get freed if an error occured.

Signed-off-by: Philippe De Swert <philippe.deswert@jollamobile.com>
2014-06-12 19:44:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a0ab408d3b P2P: Fix SD and DevDisc to limit maximum wait time per driver support
The driver may reject offchannel TX operation if the requested wait time
is longer than what the driver indicates as the maximum
remain-on-channel time. Two of the P2P action frame cases used long
enough wait times (1000 ms for DevDisc and 5000 ms for SD) that could go
beyond the limit with some drivers. Fix these to limit the maximum wait
to what the driver indicates as supported.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-12 10:49:19 +03:00
Ashok Kumar Ponnaiah
3dacd3ece7 atheros: Add support for new GCMP/CCMP/CMAC/GMAC cipher suites
Extend the set of supported cipher suites to include CCMP-256, GCMP,
GCMP-256, CMAC-256, GMAC, and GMAC-256 when ATH_GCM_SUPPORT=y is set in
the build configuration.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-09 19:21:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
737754dc2b EAP-IKEv2: Remove obsolete ccns.pl project workarounds
It does not look like there is going to be any additional use for this
old build option that could be used to build the EAP-IKEv2 peer
implementation in a way that interoperates with the eap-ikev2.ccns.pl
project. Remove the workarounds that matches incorrect implementation in
that project to clean up implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-08 12:28:36 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
aa6bf6dabc eap_proxy: Check sm != NULL more consistently
While it does not look like that eapol_sm_get_key() would ever be called
with sm == NULL, the current implementation is inconsistent on whether
that is allowed or not. Check sm != NULL consistently to avoid warnings
from static analyzers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 19:26:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4f4d51e059 TDLS: Add extra validation step for responder RSN IE length
The following kde.rsn_ie_len != peer->rsnie_i_len was already taking
care of enforcing the length to be within the target buffer length.
Anyway, this explicit check makes this clearer and matches the design in
TPK M1 processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 19:21:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1fde15a20a GAS server: Explicitly check that home realm is available
This makes the code easier to understand for static analyzers to avoid
false reports.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 19:05:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
aff0bee78a GAS server: Remove unused function parameter
This parameter was not used at all, so just remove the argument instead
of passing NULL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 19:04:17 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
86388afa56 WPS: Check for theoretical gmtime() failure
In theory, gmtime() could return NULL if the year value would not fit
into an integer. However, that cannot really happen with the current
time() value in practice. Anyway, clean up static analyzer reports by
checking for this corner case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 17:39:51 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d75a5ae018 WPS ER: Fix UDN parser to handle missing field
Must check that UDN was present before trying to parse it. Avoid a NULL
pointer dereference by checking the result before using os_strstr() when
parsing device description from an AP.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 17:35:22 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bc32bb70d7 Make a code path easier for static analyzers to understand
prev cannot be NULL here in the hostapd_eid_country_add() call since
prev is set whenever start becomes non-NULL. That seems to be a bit too
difficult for some static analyzers, so check the prev pointer
explicitly to avoid false warnings.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-07 15:37:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2a57c33e25 Reserve QCA vendor specific nl80211 commands 20..33
These are reserved for QCA use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-05 17:03:17 +03:00
Amar Singhal
84df167554 nl80211: Add vendor attribute for interface index
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-05 16:57:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9949483c2f The master branch is now used for v2.3 development
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-05 00:51:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b63b9a7bc9 Change version information for the 2.2 release
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-04 16:09:59 +03:00
Darshan Paranji Sri
95b6bca66d Add rsn_pairwise bits to set_ieee8021x() driver_ops
This fixes an issue where a driver using the deprecated set_ieee8021x()
callback did not include rsn_pairwise bits in the driver configuration
even if mixed WPA+WPA2 configuration was used. This could result, e.g.,
in CCMP not being enabled properly when wpa_pairwise=TKIP and
rsn_pairwise=CCMP was used in the configuration. Fix this by using
bitwise OR of the wpa_pairwise and rsn_pairwise values to allow the
driver to enable all pairwise ciphers.

In addition, make the newer set_ap() driver_ops use the same bitwise OR
design instead of picking between rsn_pairwise and wpa_pairwise. This
makes the code paths consistent and can also fix issues with mixed mode
configuration with set_ap().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-03 13:59:22 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
95f6f6a49d RADIUS/EAP server: Use longer username buffer to avoid truncation
If the peer provides a username with large part of it being non-ASCII
characters, the previously used buffers may not have been long enough to
include the full string in debug logs and database search due to forced
truncation of the string by printf_encode(). Avoid this by increasing
the buffer sizes to fit in the maximum result.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-02 17:36:51 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ee54e4010e tests: printf_encode unit test for bounds checking
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-02 17:36:51 +03:00
Stuart Henderson
5dff6dff63 Fix off-by-one bounds checking in printf_encode()
The off-by-one error in printf_encode() bounds checking could have
allowed buffer overflow with 0x00 being written to the memory position
following the last octet of the target buffer. Since this output is used
as \0-terminated string, the following operation would likely read past
the buffer as well. Either of these operations can result in the process
dying either due to buffer overflow protection or by a read from
unallowed address.

This has been seen to cause wpa_supplicant crash on OpenBSD when control
interface client attaches (debug print shows the client socket address).
Similarly, it may be possible to trigger the issue in RADIUS/EAP server
implementation within hostapd with a suitable constructed user name.

Signed-off-by: Stuart Henderson <sthen@openbsd.org>
2014-06-02 17:36:18 +03:00
Ashok Kumar Ponnaiah
801e117376 Fix validation of RSN EAPOL-Key version for GCMP with PMF
If PMF was enabled, the validation step for EAPOL-Key descriptor version
ended up rejecting the message if GCMP had been negotiated as the
pairwise cipher. Fix this by making the GCMP check skipped similarly to
the CCMP case if a SHA256-based AKM is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-06-02 17:03:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3d4d2348c0 FT: Fix GTK rekeying after FT protocol
Move to PTKINITDONE state and mark PTK valid after successful completion
of FT protocol. This allows the AP/Authenticator to start GTK rekeying
when FT protocol is used. Previously, the station using FT protocol did
not get the new GTK which would break delivery of group addressed
frames.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-06-01 13:21:40 +03:00
Jithu Jance
d3d048310c nl80211: Work around error case prints for nl_recvmsgs on Android
I got the below prints on a particular Android platform:

I/wpa_supplicant( 2637): nl80211: send_and_recv->nl_recvmsgs failed: 20
I/wpa_supplicant( 2637): nl80211: send_and_recv->nl_recvmsgs failed: 20

In JellyBean libnl_2 code, I see that the nl_recvmsgs returns postive values
too. In some cases, nl_recvmgs return the output of nl_recv function. nl_recv
function can return Number of bytes read, 0 or a negative error code.

Looks like this positive return value for nl_recvmsgs may be specific to
Android. While this is not how the API is supposed to work, this does no
harm with upstream libnl which returns only 0 or -1 from the function.

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2014-06-01 11:25:02 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8a387a269d P2P NFC: Fix use of freed memory
The dev_found() callback from NFC connection handover message processing
ended up using the p2p_dev_addr pointer that points to the parsed
message. However, that parsed data was freed just before the call. Fix
this by reordering the calls.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-31 23:10:33 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
13c330385a SAE: Fix memory leak in random number generation
If the randomly generated bignum does not meet the validation steps, the
iteration loop in sae_get_rand() did not free the data properly. Fix the
memory leak by freeing the temporary bignum before starting the next
attempt at generating the value.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-31 22:24:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d92bdf9602 hostapd: Make sure hapd->drv_priv gets cleared on driver deinit
Couple of code paths in hostapd.c could have left hapd->drv_priv
pointing to memory that was freed in driver_nl80211.c when a secondary
BSS interface is removed. This could result in use of freed memory and
segfault when the next driver operation (likely during interface
deinit/removal). Fix this by clearing hapd->drv_priv when there is
reason to believe that the old value is not valid within the driver
wrapper anymore.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-31 17:11:04 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
438e13339d hostapd: Use helper function to avoid duplicate deinit calls
These three calls were used already in three different paths. Use a
helper function to avoid adding even more copies of this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-31 15:57:36 +03:00
Michal Kazior
ac1a224092 hostapd: Clean up if interface setup fails
If for some reason interface setup fails mid-way when setting up
multi-BSS AP it was possible to get segmentation fault because driver
was not properly cleaned up.

One possible trigger, when using nl80211 driver, was udev renaming an
interface created by hostapd causing, e.g., linux_set_iface_flags() to
fail.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-05-31 15:53:56 +03:00
Michal Kazior
81c4fca100 hostapd: Reset hapd->interface_add properly
This variable is updated when calling hostapd_if_add(), so it makes
sense to do the same thing when calling hostapd_if_remove().

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-05-31 15:49:38 +03:00
Michal Kazior
3fbd036ea9 hostapd: Prevent double interface disabling from segfaulting
Performing, e.g. `wpa_cli -p /var/run/hostapd raw DISABLE` twice led to
hostapd segmentation fault if multiple BSSes were configured. Fix this
by checking if there is anything to disable at all before trying.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-05-31 15:46:45 +03:00
Michal Kazior
ea39367c1b nl80211: Fix wpa_driver_nl80211_if_add() failure paths
Make sure to not remove interfaces that were not created by
hostapd/wpa_supplicant. This was already done on number of the error
paths, but not all.

Signed-off-by: Michal Kazior <michal.kazior@tieto.com>
2014-05-31 13:43:27 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b523973611 RADIUS client: Trigger failover more quickly if socket is not valid
It is possible for the connect() call to fail (e.g., due to unreachable
network based on local routing table), so the current auth/acct_sock may
be left to -1. Use that as an addition trigger to allow server failover
operation to be performed more quickly if it is known that the
retransmission attempt will not succeed anyway.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-30 20:52:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
09844c0984 RADIUS client: Do not flush pending messages if server did not change
The re-open socket to the current RADIUS server code path did not work
in the expected way here. The pending authentication messages do not
need to be flushed in that case and neither should the retransmission
parameters be cleared. Fix this by performing these operations only if
the server did actually change as a part of a failover operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-30 20:46:20 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5d67bf1566 hostapd: Fix configuration of multiple RADIUS servers with SET
The current RADIUS server pointer was updated after each SET command
which broke parsing of multiple RADIUS servers over the control
interface. Fix this by doing the final RADIUS server pointer updates
only once the full configuration is available.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-30 20:40:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
70d4084885 RADIUS client: Fix socket close/re-open on server change
Both IPv4 and IPv6 sockets were not closed consistently in the paths
that tried to change RADIUS servers. This could result in leaking
sockets and leaving behind registered eloop events to freed memory on
interface removal.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-30 18:09:42 +03:00
Jerry Yang
d045cc8e4c RADIUS client: Fix crash issue in radius_client_timer()
While iterating through RADIUS messages in radius_client_timer(), one
message entry may get flushed by "radius_client_retransmit -->
radius_client_handle_send_error --> radius_client_init_auth -->
radius_change_server --> radius_client_flush". This could result in
freed memory being accessed afterwards.

Signed-off-by: Jerry Yang <xyang@sonicwall.com>
2014-05-30 18:08:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c1fb75a6e2 RADIUS client: Handle ENETUNREACH similarly to other failure cases
This is one more possible send() error that should trigger RADIUS server
change if multiple servers are configured.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-30 18:08:54 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9ed4076673 RADIUS client: Do not try to send message without socket
It is possible for the RADIUS authentication/accounting socket to not be
open even if partial RADIUS server configuration has been done through
the control interface SET commands. Previously, this resulted in send()
attempt using fd=-1 which fails with bad file descriptor. Clean this up
by logging this as a missing configuration instead of trying to send the
message when that is known to fail.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-30 18:08:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
114153b975 P2P: Debug print channel lists for invitation processing
This makes invitation process more consistent with GO Negotiation as far
as the debug log entries are concerned and the resulting log is more
helpful for understanding channel selection.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-29 16:46:28 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4eb3b76b0f OpenSSL: Fix OCSP certificate debug print to use wpa_printf
Instead of using X509_print_fp() to print directly to stdout, print the
certificate dump to a memory BIO and use wpa_printf() to get this into
the debug log. This allows redirection of debug log to work better and
avoids undesired stdout prints when debugging is not enabled.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-29 15:37:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f6fb1926bb HS 2.0R2: Fix subscr_remediation_method for RADIUS server
This configuration parameter was not used at all in the RADIUS server
implementation and instead, hard coded 0 was sent.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-28 00:56:13 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2d2dd488be tests: Add module tests for src/common
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-28 00:56:13 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
74879f320d Remove extra newline from a debug print
"Unknown WFA information element ignored" debug message had an extra
newline at the end.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-27 23:39:46 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
147848ec4d nl80211: Do not add all virtual interfaces to drv->if_indices
Commit 04eff7d5ba or something around that
timeframe may have caused a regression on how drv->if_indices gets used
with wpa_supplicant. Most (curretly likely all) wpa_supplicant virtual
interface use cases should not actually use this. This could result in
issues with P2P group interfaces delivering events to incorrect
interface (parent rather than the group interface). The previous commit
removed some of the issues, but more complete fix is to undo some of
those merged hostapd/wpa_supplicant operations.

Filter add_ifidx() uses based on hostapd vs. wpa_supplicant and iftype
to get closer to the earlier wpa_supplicant behavior for the driver
events from virtual interfaces.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-27 18:47:41 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
de88430311 nl80211: Fix del_ifidx() with mixed parent interface cases
It is possible for a virtual interface to be added and removed by
different parent interfaces. This can happen, e.g., with P2P group
interfaces if the P2P parent interface does not happen to be the first
entry in the wpa_supplicant global interface list. That first entry is
used to remove the group interface while the addition would have
happened with the dedicated P2P management interface.

This can result in the interface that added a new virtual interface
getting stuck with an obsolete ifindex value in the drv->if_indeces list
and as such, deliver some extra events to incorrect destination wpa_s
instance. In particular, this can result in INTERFACE_DISABLED event
from deletion of a P2P group interface getting delivered incorrectly to
the parent wpa_s instance which would disable that interface even though
the interface remains in enabled state.

Fix this by clearing the removed interface from all if_indeces lists
instead of just the one that was used to delete the interface. This is
the simplest approach since the ifindex is unique and there is no need
to track which interface added the new virtual interface to always hit
the same one when removing the interface.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-27 18:16:58 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f347935f0d tests: Unit tests for WPA_TRACE
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-27 00:03:06 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a3fe74bde1 tests: Add unit tests for ext_password
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-26 23:57:32 +03:00
Boris Sorochkin
f7454c97df P2P: Add 60 GHz in channel to frequency conversion
Add regulatory classes for the 60GHz band.

Signed-off-by: Vladimir Kondratiev <qca_vkondrat@qca.qualcomm.com>
Signed-off-by: Boris Sorochkin <qca_bsoroc@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-26 23:35:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
fc3f1d1b4d Remove unused hostapd_ip_diff()
There are no users of this function.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-26 17:21:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
3eb744a35a tests: int_array unit tests
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-26 17:21:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8b0980af50 tests: Move bitfield unit tests into wpa_supplicant module test
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-26 17:21:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8860e0f47c tests: Add printf encoding/decoding module tests
This replaces tests/test-printf.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-26 17:21:44 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d73c7b9626 GAS: Send error response if no room for pending dialog context
Instead of silently dropping the response that requires fragmentation,
send an error response to the station to make it aware that no full
response will be available.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-26 17:21:43 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
2396f02a43 Reserve QCA vendor specific nl80211 commands 14..19
These are reserved for QCA use.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-22 16:29:48 +03:00
Jithu Jance
5661bd0f70 P2P: Avoid resetting pending_listen_freq if p2p_listen is pending
If p2p_listen is called while previous listen command's
remain_on_channel event is pending, the p2p_listen would fail
and it used to clear pending_listen_freq. Now when the remain-
on-channel event comes from the driver, the pending_listen_freq
doesn't match and gets ignored. This was leading to a case
where listen state was getting stuck (in case of WAIT_PEER_CONNECT
state).

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2014-05-22 16:29:36 +03:00
Jithu Jance
8802326ff9 nl80211: Indicate SHA256-based AKM suites in CONNECT/ASSOCIATE
Previously, the NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES was skipped if either of these
SHA256-based AKMs was negotiated.

Signed-off-by: Jithu Jance <jithu@broadcom.com>
2014-05-21 23:48:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
54ac6ff8c4 PKCS 1: Add function for checking v1.5 RSA signature
This could be used as a step towards replacing more specific functions
used in X.509 and TLS processing.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-20 19:52:18 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d3811845f3 RSA: Add OID definitions and helper function for hash algorithms
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-19 23:27:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ab6d047405 Add function for building RSA public key from n and e parameters
This is similar to the existing functionality that parsed ASN.1-encoded
RSA public key by generating a similar public key instance from already
parsed n and e parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-19 23:27:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6c5be116dd PKCS #1: Enforce minimum padding for decryption in internal TLS
Follow the PKCS #1 v1.5, 8.1 constraint of at least eight octets long PS
for the case where the internal TLS implementation decrypts PKCS #1
formatted data. Similar limit was already in place for signature
validation, but not for this decryption routine.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-19 23:27:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e6d83cc7ba PKCS #1: Allow only BT=01 for signature in internal TLS
Based on PKCS #1, v1.5, 10.1.3, the block type shall be 01 for a
signature. This avoids a potential attack vector for internal TLS/X.509
implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-19 23:27:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9c29d48725 X.509: Fix internal TLS/X.509 validation of PKCS#1 signature
Verify that there is no extra data after the hash field. This is needed
to avoid potential attacks using additional data to construct a value
that passes the RSA operation and allows the hash value to be forged.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-19 23:27:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dbd1e184e3 tests: TNC testing
This implements minimal IMC and IMV to allow TNC testing with PEAP (SoH)
and TTLS/FAST with EAP-TNC.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-17 20:05:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
10b58b5029 TNC: Allow TNC to be enabled dynamically
Previously, hostapd had to be started with at least one of the
configuration files enabling TNC for TNC to be usable. Change this to
allow TNC to be enabled when the first interface with TNC enabled gets
added during runtime.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-17 20:05:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0a626a5060 TNC: Move common definitions into a shared header file
No need to duplicate these in multiple places.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-17 20:05:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4075e4e862 TNC: Allow tnc_config file path to be replaced
This is for enabling easier testing of TNCS/TNCC functionality as part
of the test scripts without having to use the fixed /etc/tnc_config
location that could be used by the main system and would require changes
within /etc.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-17 20:05:55 +03:00
Masashi Honma
f0356ec85c eloop: Add epoll option for better performance
This patch adds epoll option for the eloop implementation. This can be
selected with the CONFIG_ELOOP_EPOLL=y build option.

[merit]
See Table1.

Table1. comparison table
+--------+--------+-----------+------------+-------------+
|        | add fd | remove fd | prepare fd | dispatch fd |
+--------+--------+-----------+------------+-------------+
| select | O(1)   | O(1)      | O(N)       | O(N)        |
+--------+--------+-----------+------------+-------------+
| poll   | O(1)   | O(1)      | O(N)       | O(N)        |
+--------+--------+-----------+------------+-------------+
| epoll  | O(1)   | O(1)      | 0          | O(M)        |
+--------+--------+-----------+------------+-------------+
"add fd" is addition of fd by eloop_sock_table_add_sock().
"remove fd" is removal of fd by eloop_sock_table_remove_sock().
"prepare fd" is preparation of fds before wait in eloop_run().
"dispatch fd" is dispatchment of fds by eloop_sock_table_dispatch().
"N" is all watching fds.
"M" is fds which could be dispatched after waiting.

As shown in Table1, epoll option has better performance on "prepare fd" column.
Because select/poll option requires setting fds before every select()/poll().
But epoll_wait() doesn't need it.

And epoll option has also better performance on "dispatch fd" column.
Because select/poll option needs to check all registered fds to find out
dispatchable fds. But epoll option doesn't require checking all registered fds.
Because epoll_wait() returns dispatchable fd set.

So epoll option is effective for GO/AP functionality.

[demerit]
The epoll option requires additional heap memory. In case of P2P GO, it is
about 8K bytes.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-05-16 18:25:51 +03:00
Masashi Honma
da96a6f793 eloop: Separate event loop select/poll implementation
This allows yet another eloop.c option to be added.

Signed-off-by: Masashi Honma <masashi.honma@gmail.com>
2014-05-16 18:23:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5cd0e228ac P2P: Iterate through full pref_chan list in search of a valid channel
p2p_get_pref_freq() went through the full list only if the channels
arguments was provided. If no channel list contraint was in place, the
first pref_chan item was picked regardless of whether it is valid
channel and as such, a later valid entry could have been ignored. Allow
this to loop through all the entries until a valid channel is found or
the end of the pref_chan list is reached. As an extra bonus, this
simplifies the p2p_get_pref_freq() implementation quite a bit.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-16 16:49:17 +03:00
Rajkumar Manoharan
f41d55da02 hostapd: Check for overlapping 20 MHz BSS before starting 20/40 MHz BSS
Before starting a 20/40 MHz BSS on the 2.4 GHz band, a 40-MHz-capable HT
AP is required by the rules defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012 10.15.5 to
examine the channels of the current operational regulatory domain to
determine whether the operation of a 20/40 MHz BSS might unfairly
interfere with the operation of existing 20 MHz BSSs. The AP (or some of
its associated HT STAs) is required to scan all of the channels of the
current regulatory domain in order to ascertain the operating channels
of any existing 20 MHz BSSs and 20/40 MHz BSSs. (IEEE 802.11-2012 S.5.2
Establishing a 20/40 MHz BSS).

Add the check for an overlapping 20 MHz BSS to the initial AP scan for
the P == OT_i case in 10.15.3.2.

Signed-off-by: Rajkumar Manoharan <rmanohar@qti.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-16 01:14:01 +03:00
Simon Baatz
c70c37500b SCARD: Fix GSM authentication on USIM
scard_gsm_auth() used SIM_CMD_GET_RESPONSE for both SIM and USIM. Convert
the command into USIM_CMD_GET_RESPONSE for USIM.

Since commit eb32460029 ("Fix switching from EAP-SIM to EAP-AKA/AKA'")
EAP-SIM is using the USIM if available. This triggers a probably ancient
bug in scard_gsm_auth(), which results in sending the wrong get response
command to the USIM. Thus, EAP-SIM stopped to work after this change on
USIMs that expect the proper command.

Signed-off-by: Simon Baatz <gmbnomis@gmail.com>
2014-05-16 01:01:25 +03:00
Petar Koretic
c78c6b73fa WPS: Fix return value when context is not valid
If WPS isn't enabled, hostapd_cli returns 'OK' even though WPS doesn't
get activated because WPS context is not valid:

$ hostapd_cli wps_pbc
Selected interface 'wlan0'
OK

$ hostapd_cli wps_cancel
Selected interface 'wlan0'
OK

Fix this by returning appropriate error when WPS fails to activate:

$ hostapd_cli wps_pbc
Selected interface 'wlan0'
FAIL

$ hostapd_cli wps_cancel
Selected interface 'wlan0'
FAIL

Signed-off-by: Petar Koretic <petar.koretic@sartura.hr>
CC: Luka Perkov <luka.perkov@sartura.hr>
2014-05-16 00:58:48 +03:00
Rashmi Ramanna
388444e8d6 P2P: Modify the timeout for GO Negotiation on no concurrent session
Peer should handle a GO Negotiation exchange correctly when the
responding device does not have WSC credentials available at the
time of receiving the GO Negotiation Request. WSC Credentials
(e.g., Pushbutton) can be entered within the 120 second timeout.

Presently, if concurrent session is not active, the peer would wait for
GO Negotiation Request frame from the other device for approximately one
minute due to the earlier optimization change in commit
a2d6365760. To meet the two minute
requirement, replace this design based on number of iterations with a
more appropriate wait for the required number of seconds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-15 23:57:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
7e68be38e4 P2P: Refrain from performing extended listen during PD
Extend the previous commit 0f1034e388 to
skip extended listen also based on ongoing provision discovery operation
(which does not show up as a separate P2P module state and as such, was
not coveraged by the previous commit).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-15 22:19:37 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c7caac56b7 nl80211: Fix send_frame freq for IBSS
bss->freq was not updated for IBSS, so whatever old value was stored
from a previous AP mode operation could end up having been used as the
channel when trying to send Authentication frames in an RSN IBSS. This
resulted in the frame not sent (cfg80211 rejects it) and potentially not
being able to re-establish connection due to 4-way handshake failing
with replay counter mismatches. Fix this by learning the operating
channel of the IBSS both when join event is received and when a
management frame is being transmitted since the IBSS may have changed
channels due to merges.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-15 16:56:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
f4626235de EAP-pwd server: Allow fragment_size to be configured
Previously, the fragment_size parameter was ignored and the default
value of 1020 was hardcoded.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-11 22:47:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c876dcd70f EAP-IKEv2: Allow frag ack without integrity checksum
RFC 5106 is not exactly clear on the requirements for the "no data"
packet that is used to acknowledge a fragmented message. Allow it to be
processed without the integrity checksum data field since it is possible
to interpret the RFC as this not being included. This fixes reassembly
of fragmented frames after keys have been derived.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-11 22:47:25 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0f73c642cc EAP-pwd: Fix processing of group setup failure
If invalid group was negotiated, compute_password_element() left some of
the data->grp pointer uninitialized and this could result in
segmentation fault when deinitializing the EAP method. Fix this by
explicitly clearing all the pointer with eap_zalloc(). In addition,
speed up EAP failure reporting in this type of error case by indicating
that the EAP method execution cannot continue anymore on the peer side
instead of waiting for a timeout.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-11 21:24:05 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
13e2574f7d EAP-pwd peer: Export Session-Id through getSessionId callback
EAP-pwd was already deriving the EAP Session-Id, but it was not yet
exposed through the EAP method API.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-11 21:22:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
251c53e084 RADIUS: Define EAP-Key-Name
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-11 21:10:03 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
04cad507e1 EAP-SIM peer: Fix counter-too-small message building
The extra data (nonce_s) used in this message was pointing to the
parsed, decrypted data and that buffer was previously freed just before
building the new message. This resulted in use of freed data and
possibly incorrect extra data value that caused the authentication
attempt to fail. Fix this by reordering the code to free the decrypted
data only after the new message has been generated. This was already the
case for EAP-AKA/AKA', but somehow missing from EAP-SIM.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-11 17:57:28 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
144f10446a X.509: Fix v3 parsing with issuerUniqueID/subjectUniqueID present
The current position pointer was not updated when issuerUniqueID or
subjectUniqueID were present. This could result in extensions being
ignored.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-05-10 13:13:47 +03:00
Sunil Dutt
0f1034e388 P2P: Refrain from performing extended listen during P2P connection
Do not perform extended listen period operations when either a P2P
connection is in progress. This makes the connection more robust should
an extended listen timer trigger during such an operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:42:44 +03:00
Hu Wang
8d0dd4eebc Add macsec_qca driver wrapper
This is based on driver_wired.c and provides driver interface for the
QCA MACsec driver.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:42:44 +03:00
Hu Wang
887d9d01ab MACsec: Add PAE implementation
This adds initial implementation of IEEE Std 802.1X-2010 PAE for MACsec.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:42:44 +03:00
Hu Wang
7baec808ef MACsec: Add driver_ops
This defines new driver_ops to be used with MACsec.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:05:28 +03:00
Hu Wang
4e9528cce3 MACsec: Add common IEEE 802.1X definitions
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:05:28 +03:00
Hu Wang
3bcfab8794 MACsec: Add define for EAPOL type MKA
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:05:28 +03:00
Hu Wang
0836c04b30 MACsec: Allow EAPOL version 3 to be configured
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:05:28 +03:00
Hu Wang
49be483b28 Add function to fetch EAP Session-Id from EAPOL supplicant
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 20:05:28 +03:00
Chandrasekaran, Manishekar
ea40a575ae nl80211: Use max associated STAs information in AP mode
Propagate max associated STAs in AP mode advertised by the driver to
core wpa_supplicant implemantion. This allows wpa_supplicant to update
the P2P GO group limit information automatically without having to
configure this limit manually. The information (if available) is also
used in the generic AP implementation to control maximum number of STA
entries.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-05-09 17:12:19 +03:00
Eliad Peller
e4fa8b120b wpa_supplicant: Add Wake-on-WLAN configuration support
Add a new wowlan_triggers option to wpa_supplicant.conf. The triggers in
this key will be used to configure the kernel wowlan configuration.

For now, support only simple flags. More complex triggers can be added
later on.

Signed-off-by: Eliad Peller <eliadx.peller@intel.com>
2014-04-29 18:59:12 +03:00
Dmitry Shmidt
959214b260 Android: Use extended P2P functionality (ANDROID_P2P) for all vendors
Signed-off-by: Dmitry Shmidt <dimitrysh@google.com>
2014-04-29 18:59:12 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
9a41232165 TDLS: Fully tear down existing link before setup
Disabling the link only clears the local state. The remote peer will
still think we are connected and disallow the setup.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-04-29 18:59:12 +03:00
Arik Nemtsov
c04b4651f7 TDLS: Disable links during AP deauth in external flow
When de-authenticating from the AP, disable each TDLS link after
sending the teardown packet. Postpone the reset of the peer state
data until after the link disable request.

Signed-off-by: Arik Nemtsov <arikx.nemtsov@intel.com>
2014-04-29 18:59:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
b19719aa77 TDLS: Make wpa_tdls_send_teardown() static
This function was not used anywhere outside tdls.c.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 18:59:12 +03:00
Ilan Peer
52f5877afa nl80211: Take ownership of dynamically added interfaces
Indicate to cfg80211 that interfaces created by the wpa_supplicant
or hostapd are owned by them, and that in case that the socket that
created them closes, these interfaces should be removed.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-04-29 18:59:12 +03:00
Eduardo Abinader
e390df0553 nl80211: Cancel rfkill timeout on deinit
Got segfault, when freeing drv and there exists registered timeout for
blocked rfkill. This patch adds cancel timeout to avoid this.

Signed-off-by: Eduardo Abinader <eduardo.abinader@openbossa.org>
2014-04-29 17:55:27 +03:00
Pradeep Reddy POTTETI
bb24229b26 TDLS: Pass peer's capability info to the driver in open mode
Commit 96ecea5eb1 did not consider
to pass the VHT/HT/WMM capabilities of the peer for BSS with
open mode.
Address this issue by passing the capabilities irrespective of
the security mode.

Signed-off-by: Pradeep Reddy POTTETI <c_ppotte@qti.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 17:08:13 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
c0333c8dd5 Check rx_mgmt::frame more consistently against NULL
If a driver wrapper misbehaves and does not indicate a frame body in the
event, core hostapd code should handle this consistently since that case
was already checked for in one location.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d6c6b1fb9d Make sta NULL-check easier for static analyzers
sta == NULL check is already done above based on category !=
WLAN_ACTION_PUBLIC, but that seems to be too complex for some static
analyzers, so avoid invalid reports by explicitly checking for this
again in the WLAN_ACTION_FT case.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0bceb8d6f4 Make dl_list_first() and dl_list_last() uses easier for static analyzers
The previous check for dl_list_len() or having an entry from the list is
sufficient, but some static analyzers cannot figure out that
dl_list_first() and dl_list_last() will return non-NULL in this type of
cases. Avoid invalid reports by explicitly checking for NULL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5f693cb1b6 WPS HTTP: Remove unused assignment
bbp is not used in the code path that skips trailers.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ee4fefc015 Remove duplicated variable zeroing
It's enough to do this once as part of the for loop.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
4a9d0ebe4a Make PMKID check easier for static analyzers
Checking sm->pmksa is sufficient here, but that seems to be too
difficult for static analyzers to follow, so avoid false reports by
explicitly checking pmkid as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
06df2aa60a Remove floating constant suffix 'd' from test coee
clang scan-build does not seem to like the 'd' suffix on floating
constants and ends up reporting analyzer failures. Since this suffix
does not seem to be needed, get rid of it to clear such warnings.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d06e9ac5f5 P2P: Verify operating channel validity for NFC connection handover
p2p_freq_to_channel() could return an error if the GO or P2P Client
operating channel is not valid. Check for this before generating the NFC
handover message.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
13a524a30d nl80211: Remove unnecessary wpa_driver_nl80211_set_freq() wrapper
This is not of any real use anymore with nl80211_set_channel() taking
care of channel setting operation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:52:10 +03:00
Peng Xu
e87ef7517e nl80211: Add support for changing AP mode channel bandwidth
Configure driver with the new channel parameters (mainly, HT 20/40 MHz
bandwidth changes) as part of set_ap().

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:52:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
30575183f6 Sync with mac80211-next.git nl80211.h
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-29 12:52:09 +03:00
Peng Xu
5f0bca77a8 Retry initial 20/40 MHz co-ex scan if the driver is busy
This makes the initial OBSS scans in AP mode before starting 40 MHz BSS
more robust. In addition, HT20 can be used as a backup option if none of
the scans succeed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:52:09 +03:00
Peng Xu
587d60d2b7 Add AP mode support for HT 20/40 co-ex Action frame
If a 2.4 GHz band AP receives a 20/40 Coexistence management frame from
a connected station with 20/40 BSS Intolerant Channel Report element
containing the channel list in which any legacy AP are detected or AP
with 40 MHz intolerant bit set in HT Cap IE is detected in the affected
range of the BSS, the BSS will be moved from 40 to 20 MHz channel width.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:52:09 +03:00
Peng Xu
9c47f6a2a6 hostapd: Extend support for HT 20/40 coexistence feature
Extend the minimal HT 20/40 co-ex support to include dynamic changes
during the lifetime of the BSS. If any STA connects to a 2.4 GHz AP with
40 MHz intolerant bit set then the AP will switch to 20 MHz operating
mode.

If for a period of time specified by OBSS delay factor and OBSS scan
interval AP does not have any information about 40 MHz intolerant STAs,
the BSS is switched from HT20 to HT40 mode.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:52:09 +03:00
Peng Xu
196c9c7cd2 Make channel parameters available in set_ap() driver operation
This provides information to allow the driver to be configured for
updated channel parameters, e.g., when dynamically changing HT20/HT40
bandwidth.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-29 12:16:51 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
27b418715f WPS: Print setsockopt() failure in debug log
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-28 16:54:09 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
52cb20730a trace: Replace demangle.h with internal defines
It looks like the demangle.h from binutils-dev is not installed that
commonly anymore. Since we need only two defines from that file, replace
the header file with those defines to make it easier to build with
WPA_TRACE_BFD=y.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-25 19:27:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0e80ea2c70 nl80211: Fix some coding style issues
Some trailing whitespace and spaces for indentation were present in the
driver wrapper and header files.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-25 19:27:07 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
a26582cb98 Make qca-vendor.h independent of other header files
Move the definitions that depended in common.h into a separate header
file so that qca-vendor.h can be copied and used as-is in other
projects.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-25 11:41:36 +03:00
Amar Singhal
4a64d5a9db nl80211: Allocate QCA vendor subcmd for extended statistics
This allocates a QCA vendor subcmd for extended statistics
functionality and also an attribute for delivering the payload
for extended statistics.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-25 11:36:11 +03:00
Ilan Peer
dcdce14741 radiotap: Fix compilation for systems without le16toh/le32toh
These functions are not standard and do not exist in all systems, e.g.,
variants of Android. Instead use the macros defined in common.h.

Signed-off-by: Ilan Peer <ilan.peer@intel.com>
2014-04-24 12:15:32 +03:00
Maxime Bizon
2aa82e52da Interworking: Don't filter probe requests when interworking is disabled
With hidden SSID (ignore_broadcast_ssid), an IOS device trying to
connect to the AP will send a probe request with ANT == 2. If
interworking support is just compiled (not enabled), we will drop the
probe request since default ANT is 0.

Check that interworking is enabled before filtering based on ANT or
HESSID to match the behavior of code without CONFIG_INTERWORKING.

Signed-off-by: Maxime Bizon <mbizon@freebox.fr>
2014-04-24 12:15:32 +03:00
Naresh Jayaram
13f6a07efc Add SIM identifier to the network profile and cred block
This allows the specific SIM to be identified for authentication
purposes in multi-SIM devices. This SIM number represents the index of
the SIM slot. This SIM number shall be used for the authentication using
the respective SIM for the Wi-Fi connection to the corresponding
network.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-24 12:15:32 +03:00
Marek Puzyniak
8a0f3bf613 AP: Fix checking if DFS is required
Sometimes function hostapd_is_dfs_required() returns -1 which indicates
that it was not possible to check if DFS was required. This happens for
channels from the 2.4 GHz band where DFS checking should not happen.
This can be fixed by returning DFS-not-required for mode different from
IEEE80211A and when DFS support is not available (ieee80211h not set).

Signed-off-by: Marek Puzyniak <marek.puzyniak@tieto.com>
2014-04-17 17:12:52 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
6d99bd8076 nl80211: Debug print HT/VHT capability override information
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-17 17:11:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d2c33b91ad Reduce the amount of time PTK/TPTK/GTK is kept in memory
Some of the buffers used to keep a copy of PTK/TPTK/GTK in the
supplicant implementation maintained a copy of the keys longer than
necessary. Clear these buffers to zero when the key is not needed
anymore to minimize the amount of time key material is kept in memory.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-16 01:29:27 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e47ee249bc l2_packet: Fix l2_packet_none (hostapd default)
The sample code here ended up trying to register an eloop socket with fd
== -1. This was not really ever supposed to be used, but it is now also
hitting an assert in eloop. Skip the unnecessary
eloop_register_read_sock() to avoid this.

This was causing issues for hostapd since CONFIG_L2_PACKET is not set by
default. If CONFIG_RSN_PREAUTH=y was not used for CONFIG_L2_PACKET was
not set in .config explicitly, the defaul use of l2_packet_none.c ended
up hitting the newly added assert() in eloop.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-14 23:04:55 +03:00
Johannes Berg
30476e4fe7 wlantest: Tag and ignore generated packets
Rather than ignoring packets with a minimal 8-byte radiotap
header, which may occur elsewhere, tag generated (decrypted)
packets with an empty vendor namespace tag and ignore those.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-04-13 23:54:25 +03:00
Johannes Berg
bacb984b2d radiotap: Update radiotap parser to library version
Update the radiotap parser to the latest version of the
http://git.sipsolutions.net/radiotap.git/ library to get
parsing for vendor namespaces.

Signed-off-by: Johannes Berg <johannes.berg@intel.com>
2014-04-13 23:49:59 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
142817b2f9 Add a wpa_supplicant ctrl_iface event for regdom changes
CTRL-EVENT-REGDOM-CHANGE event provides an external notification of
regulatory domain (and any driver channel list) changes.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-13 16:32:38 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
d6a36f3956 nl80211: Mask out deauth even after own deauth request
This was already done for the disconnect event, but
SME-in-wpa_supplicant case needs to do same with the deauth event to
avoid getting extra events during WPS disconnect-and-reconnect sequence.
This can speed up WPS processing by removing unnecessary failures or
retries due to the extra event being processed during the next
association attempt.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-13 11:39:49 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
0cd860284c Add CTRL-EVENT-SIGNAL-CHANGE for bgscan signal update events
This allows external programs to monitor driver signal change events
through wpa_supplicant when bgscan is used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-13 10:26:52 +03:00
Felix Fietkau
83c4cb5217 nl80211: Handle multiple interface combinations for P2P
The first combination may allow single-channel concurrency for
P2P + managed, but there may be others that allow multi-channel
concurrency. Parse all of them to find the maximum number of channels.

Signed-off-by: Felix Fietkau <nbd@openwrt.org>
2014-04-11 19:22:00 +03:00
Nirav Shah
0e0e1e564f P2P: Add retry mechanism for GO Negotiation Confirmation
wpa_supplicant now retries for P2P_GO_NEG_CNF_MAX_RETRY_COUNT times if
it doesn't receive acknowledgement for GO Negotiation Confirmation
frame. Currently, P2P_GO_NEG_CNF_MAX_RETRY_COUNT is set to 1.

While this is not strictly speaking following the P2P specification,
this can improve robustness of GO Negotiation in environments with
interference and also with peer devices that do not behave properly
(e.g., by not remaining awake on the negotiation channel through the
full GO Negotiation).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-11 11:57:05 +03:00
Abhishek Singh
9392c9be7a nl80211: Use LEAVE_IBSS with driver-based-SME
NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS was used only with wpa_supplicant-based SME.
Extend this to drivers that implement SME internally.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-10 19:51:51 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
bb52293e71 OpenSSL: Detect and prevent TLS heartbeat attack
Some OpenSSL versions have vulnerability in TLS heartbeat request
processing. Check the processed message to determine if the attack has
been used and if so, do not send the response to the peer. This does not
prevent the buffer read overflow within OpenSSL, but this prevents the
attacker from receiving the information.

This change is an additional layer of protection if some yet to be
identified paths were to expose this OpenSSL vulnerability. However, the
way OpenSSL is used for EAP-TLS/TTLS/PEAP/FAST in hostapd/wpa_supplicant
was already rejecting the messages before the response goes out and as
such, this additional change is unlikely to be needed to avoid the
issue.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-09 14:58:48 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1aa6f953bb WNM: Fix neighbor report subelement parser
Only the Neighbor Report element should be included here, so verify that
the element id matches. In addition, verify that each subelement has
valid length before using the data.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-08 01:01:55 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
5583b8d1eb Document and rename HT Capability/Operation fields
This makes the definitions match the terminology used in IEEE Std
802.11-2012 and makes it easier to understand how the HT Operation
element subfields are used.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-07 22:45:11 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1dde5b5cdd Remove PSMP option from ht_capab
This was used to fill in the "PSMP support" subfield that was defined
during P802.11n development. However, this subfield was marked reserved
in the published IEEE Std 802.11n-2009 and it is not supported by
current drivers that use hostapd for SME either. As such, there is not
much point in maintaining this field as ht_capab parameter within
hostapd either.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-07 22:02:14 +03:00
Amarnath Hullur Subramanyam
4a16a0bd55 nl80211: Add QCA vendor subcmd for NAN
QCA vendor extension is used for NAN functionality. This defines the
subcommand and attribute to address this.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-07 17:13:08 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
dc39004318 WPS: Remove unused WEP related functionality
Now that WPS 2.0 support is enabled unconditionally, WEP and Shared auth
type are not allowed. This made some of the older code unused and that
can now be removed to clean up the implementation. There is still one
place where WEP is allowed for testing purposes: wpa_supplicant as
Registrar trying to configure an AP to use WEP. That is now only allowed
in CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS=y builds, though.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-06 12:31:45 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9437c2d0ea EAP-pwd peer: Fix fragmentation of PWD-Confirm-Resp
This is somewhat of a corner case since there is no real point in using
so short a fragmentation threshold that it would result in this message
getting fragmented. Anyway, it is better be complete and support this
case as well.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-06 00:51:00 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
48f668eecf EAP-pwd: Fix memory leak on error path with fragmentation
If fragmentation is used, the temporary inbuf/outbuf could have been
leaked in error cases (e.g., reaching maximum number of roundtrips).

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-06 00:34:30 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
9ff4de6de4 Move DROP_SA command to be within ifdef CONFIG_TESTING_OPTIONS
This is a test command and has no use in production builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-05 23:59:31 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
e1a273a61d Remove used KDE addition code from EAPOL-Key msg 4/4
EAPOL-Key msg 4/4 has no specified KDE use, so remove the unused code to
simplify the implementation.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-05 23:30:16 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
76d3fb1eeb Remove unused wpa_sm_get_param() function
This function was not used anywhere and was not up-to-date with
full tet of parameters.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-05 20:42:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
ed429931a0 TDLS: Add test mode for MIC failure testing
"SET tdls_testing 0x800" can be used to enable a special test mode that
forces the FTIE MIC in TDLS setup messages to be incorrect.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-04-05 20:42:12 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1619e9d512 Interworking: Add ctrl_iface events on cred block modifications
Following events are now sent to ctrl_iface monitors to indicate if
credential blocks have been added, modified, or removed:

CRED-ADDED <id>
CRED-MODIFIED <id> <field>
CRED-REMOVE <id>

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-04-04 19:10:47 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
21611ea9fd edit: Increase buffer size to 4096 bytes
wpa_supplicant and wpa_cli had already moved to allowing up to 4096 byte
buffer size to be used for control interface commands. This was limited
by the line edit buffer in interactive mode. Increase that limit to
match the other buffers to avoid artificially truncating long commands.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-31 12:30:50 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
1e03c6cb7d XML: Remove forgotten, unused definition of debug_print_func
Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-31 12:25:13 +03:00
Jouni Malinen
8943cc998a RADIUS server: Add support for MAC ACL
"user" MACACL "password" style lines in the eap_user file can now be
used to configured user entries for RADIUS-based MAC ACL.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-29 19:31:56 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
dc87541e1e Clean up debug print for PSK file search
p2p_dev_addr was not NULL, so the all zeros case was printed as well.
Clean this up by printing p2p_dev_addr in debug prints only if it is a
real P2P Device Address.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-29 09:50:51 +02:00
Janusz Dziedzic
bbbacbf2f8 DFS: Print CAC info in ctrl_iface STATUS command
Print CAC time and CAC left time in control interface STATUS command.

Signed-off-by: Janusz Dziedzic <janusz.dziedzic@tieto.com>
2014-03-28 23:02:45 +02:00
Maxime Bizon
5c9da160a5 nl80211: Set all BSS interfaces down when tearing down AP in MBSS mode
If the interface was not added by hostapd, it could have been left up
when disabling the AP.

Signed-off-by: Maxime Bizon <mbizon@freebox.fr>
2014-03-27 16:45:25 +02:00
Avraham Stern
3ae8b7b7a2 hostapd: Add vendor command support
Add support of vendor command to hostapd ctrl_iface.
Vendor command's format:
VENDOR <vendor id> <sub command id> [<hex formatted data>]

The 3rd argument will be converted to binary data and then passed as
argument to the sub command.

Signed-off-by: Avraham Stern <avraham.stern@intel.com>
2014-03-27 15:28:44 +02:00
Pawel Kulakowski
74a1319e50 Fix issue with incorrect secondary_channel in HT40/HT80
When primary and secondary channel were switched and config was
reloaded, secondary channel was incorrectly overwritten.

Proceed as for other settings that should not be changed and don't
allow to overwrite.

Signed-off-by: Pawel Kulakowski <pawel.kulakowski@tieto.com>
2014-03-27 15:22:39 +02:00
Sunil Dutt
96ecea5eb1 Pass TDLS peer capability information in tdls_mgmt
While framing the TDLS Setup Confirmation frame, the driver needs to
know if the TDLS peer is VHT/HT/WMM capable and thus shall construct the
VHT/HT operation / WMM parameter elements accordingly. Supplicant
determines if the TDLS peer is VHT/HT/WMM capable based on the presence
of the respective IEs in the received TDLS Setup Response frame.

The host driver should not need to parse the received TDLS Response
frame and thus, should be able to rely on the supplicant to indicate
the capability of the peer through additional flags while transmitting
the TDLS Setup Confirmation frame through tdls_mgmt operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-27 15:18:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
78cd7e69de Sync with wireless-testing.git include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h
This brings in nl80211 definitions as of 2014-03-25.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-27 14:50:39 +02:00
Maxime Bizon
b36935be1a nl80211: Fix EAPOL frames not being delivered
When hostapd choose to reuse an existing interface, it does not add it
to the set of interfaces from which we accept EAPOL packets.

Make sure we always add it to that set.

Signed-off-by: Maxime Bizon <mbizon@freebox.fr>
2014-03-26 16:37:42 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6997f8baab nl80211: Set interface address even if using old interface
If an existing interface is allowed to be used, its address better be
updated to match the requested one.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-26 16:33:03 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
9b4d9c8bbc nl80211: Print if_indices list in debug log
This makes it easier to debug dynamic interface addition/removal.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-26 00:42:24 +02:00
Maxime Bizon
762c41ae99 eloop: Add assert() on negative fd when using select() code path
Signed-off-by: Maxime Bizon <mbizon@freebox.fr>
2014-03-26 00:17:07 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
163f801ef2 nl80211: Indicate HS 2.0 OSEN AKM in connect/associate command
This allows drivers that build the WPA/RSN IEs internally to use similar
design for building the OSEN IE.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-25 18:33:21 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
c201f93a9e WPS: Enable WSC 2.0 support unconditionally
There is not much point in building devices with WPS 1.0 only supported
nowadays. As such, there is not sufficient justification for maintaining
extra complexity for the CONFIG_WPS2 build option either. Remove this by
enabling WSC 2.0 support unconditionally.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-25 18:33:21 +02:00
Rashmi Ramanna
41d5ce9e0b P2P: Optimize scan for GO during persistent group invocation
Scan for GO on the negotiated operating channel for few iterations
before searching on all the supported channels during persistent group
reinvocation. In addition, use the already known SSID of the group in
the scans. These optimizations reduce group formation time.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-25 15:38:33 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4d1e38be9e ACS: Fix number of error path issues
Especially when multiple BSSes are used with ACS, number of the error
paths were not cleaning up driver initialization properly. This could
result in using freed memory and crashing the process if ACS failed.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-25 13:12:29 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
692ec3058b FT: Add support for postponing FT response
If the PMK-R1 needs to be pulled for the R0KH, the previous
implementation ended up rejecting the over-the-air authentication and
over-the-DS action frame unnecessarily while waiting for the RRB
response. Improve this by postponing the Authentication/Action frame
response until the pull response is received.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-23 18:31:06 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
6ace13a9e5 P2P: Clean up channel selection code to use helper functions
This moves some of the p2p_prepare_channel_best() functionality into
separate helper functions to make the implementation easier to read.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-23 11:01:59 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
70c35233ae WPS: Comment out unused AP WEP config write with WPS 2.0
The main WPS code rejects WEP parameters, so this code is not used and
can be commented out from WPS 2.0 builds. This is similar to the earlier
commit that commented out in-memory update.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-22 23:31:39 +02:00
Arif Hussain
c3ba70f4d0 P2P: Update op_reg_class in random social channel case
Commit 94b84bc725 missed one path where
p2p->op_reg_class should have been updated. Set this to 81 during
operating channel selection from 2.4 GHz.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-22 22:44:53 +02:00
Amar Singhal
70634eec0c hostapd: Check driver DFS offload capability for channel disablement
If the driver supports full offloading of DFS operations, do not disable
a channel marked for radar detection. The driver will handle the needed
operations for such channels.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-22 21:31:15 +02:00
Amar Singhal
65d645ce43 nl80211: Fetch DFS offload capability from driver
This uses a QCA vendor extension to determine if the driver supports
fully offloaded DFS operations.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-22 21:20:32 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
a500f3102f WPS: Comment out unused AP WEP config update with WPS 2.0
The main WPS code rejects WEP parameters, so this code is not used and
can be commented out from WPS 2.0 builds.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-22 19:22:10 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1d4fe3bcbc Remove unnecessary parameter validation
This is dead code since this helper function is always called with
non-NULL pointer.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <j@w1.fi>
2014-03-22 16:25:28 +02:00
Arif Hussain
94b84bc725 P2P: Avoid unsafe pre-configured channel as channel preference
Do not select pre-configured channel as operating channel preference if
it is unavailable maybe due to interference or possible known
co-existence constraints, and try to select random available channel.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-22 10:20:08 +02:00
Pawel Kulakowski
513dcec656 Don't overwrite channel on hostapd config reload
There was possibility that the current channel in Beacon information
element was incorrectly set. This problem was easily observed when
primary and secondary channel were switched and then some of hostapd
settings (for example password) were changed using WPS External
Registrar. This caused hostapd_reload_config() function overwrite the
current channel information from config file.

This patch prevents this situation and does not allow to overwrite
channel and some other settings when config is reloaded.

Signed-off-by: Pawel Kulakowski <pawel.kulakowski@tieto.com>
2014-03-21 23:30:57 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
20ff2642e1 WPS: Clear WPS data on init failure
It was possible for hapd->wps_beacon_ie and hapd->wps_probe_resp_ie to
be set if WPS initialization in hostapd failed after having set these
parameters (e.g., during UPnP configuration). In addition, many of the
other WPS configuration parameters that were allocated during the first
part of the initialization were not properly freed on error paths.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-21 13:23:23 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
f19e370e15 WPS: Do not advertise WPA/WPA2-Enterprise Auth Type Flags
While the device itself may support WPA/WPA2-Enterprise, enrollment of
credentials for EAP authentication is not supported through WPS. As
such, there is no need to claim support for these capabilities within
WPS information.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-20 15:13:48 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
1b5df9e591 nl80211: Do not indicate scan started event on scan_for_auth
The scan_for_auth workaround for cfg80211 missing a BSS entry for the
target BSS during authentication uses a single channel scan controlled
within driver_nl80211.c. This operation does not indicate
EVENT_SCAN_RESULTS to the upper layer code. However, it did report
EVENT_SCAN_STARTED and this resulted in the radio work protection code
assuming that an external program triggered a scan, but that scan never
completed. This resulted in all new radio work items getting stuck
waiting for this scan to complete.

Fix this by handling the scan_for_auth situation consistently within
driver_nl80211.c by filtering both the EVENT_SCAN_STARTED and
EVENT_SCAN_RESULTS.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-18 22:48:44 +02:00
Jouni Malinen
4d65deda7f HS 2.0R2: Clean up debug from libcurl
Do not truncate CURLINFO entries on first linefeed to get full IN/OUT
headers and data into debug log. Use wpa_hexdump_ascii() if any
non-displayable characters are included. Remove the separate header/data
debug dumps since all that information is now available from the debug
callback.

Signed-off-by: Jouni Malinen <jouni@qca.qualcomm.com>
2014-03-18 00:39:35 +02:00